3 @setfilename coreutils.info
5 @settitle GNU Coreutils @value{VERSION}
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @set txicodequoteundirected
8 @set txicodequotebacktick
13 @include constants.texi
15 @c Define new indices.
19 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
29 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
30 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
31 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
32 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
35 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
36 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
37 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
39 @dircategory Individual utilities
41 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
42 * b2sum: (coreutils)b2sum invocation. Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
43 * base32: (coreutils)base32 invocation. Base32 encode/decode data.
44 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
45 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
46 * basenc: (coreutils)basenc invocation. Encoding/decoding of data.
47 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
48 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
49 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
50 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change access permissions.
51 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners and groups.
52 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
53 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
54 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
55 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
56 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
57 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
58 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
59 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
60 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system usage.
61 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
62 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
63 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
64 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report file usage.
65 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
66 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
67 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
68 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
69 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
70 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
71 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
72 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
73 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
74 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
75 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
76 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
77 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
78 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy files and set attributes.
79 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
80 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
81 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
82 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
83 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
84 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
85 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
86 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
87 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
88 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
89 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
90 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
91 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
92 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
93 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
94 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
95 * numfmt: (coreutils)numfmt invocation. Reformat numbers.
96 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
97 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
98 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
99 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
100 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
101 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
102 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
103 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
104 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
105 * realpath: (coreutils)realpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
106 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
107 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
108 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
109 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
110 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
111 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
112 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
113 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
114 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
115 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
116 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
117 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
118 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
119 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
120 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
121 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Sync files to stable storage.
122 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
123 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
124 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
125 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
126 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
127 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
128 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
129 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
130 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
131 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
132 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
133 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
134 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
135 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
136 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
137 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
138 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
139 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
140 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
141 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
142 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
143 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
147 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the GNU core
148 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
150 Copyright @copyright{} 1994--2024 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
153 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
154 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
155 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
156 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
157 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
158 Free Documentation License''.
163 @title GNU @code{Coreutils}
164 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
165 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
166 @author David MacKenzie et al.
169 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
182 @cindex core utilities
183 @cindex text utilities
184 @cindex shell utilities
185 @cindex file utilities
188 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
189 * Common options:: Common options
190 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base32 base64 basenc
191 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
192 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
193 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum b2sum md5sum sha1sum sha2
194 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
195 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
196 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
197 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
198 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
199 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
200 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
201 * File space usage:: df du stat sync truncate
202 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
203 * Conditions:: false true test expr
205 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
206 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
207 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
208 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
209 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
210 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf timeout
211 * Process control:: kill
213 * Numeric operations:: factor numfmt seq
214 * File permissions:: Access modes
215 * File timestamps:: File timestamp issues
216 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
217 * Version sort ordering:: Details on version-sort algorithm
218 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
219 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
220 * Concept index:: General index
223 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
227 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
228 * Backup options:: Backup options
229 * Block size:: Block size
230 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
231 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
232 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
233 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
234 * Target directory:: Target directory
235 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
236 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
237 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
238 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
239 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation
241 Output of entire files
243 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
244 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
245 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
246 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
247 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
248 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
249 * basenc invocation:: Transform data into printable data
251 Formatting file contents
253 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
254 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
255 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
257 Output of parts of files
259 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
260 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
261 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
262 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
266 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
267 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
268 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
269 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
270 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
271 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
272 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
274 Operating on sorted files
276 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
277 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
278 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
279 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
280 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
281 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
283 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
285 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
286 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
287 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
288 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
289 * Compatibility in ptx:: The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
293 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
294 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
295 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
297 Operating on characters
299 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
300 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
301 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
303 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
305 * Character arrays:: Specifying arrays of characters
306 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
307 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters
311 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
312 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
313 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
314 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
316 @command{ls}: List directory contents
318 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
319 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
320 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
321 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
322 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
326 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
327 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
328 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
329 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
330 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
331 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
335 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
336 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
337 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
338 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
339 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
340 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
341 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
342 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
344 Changing file attributes
346 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
347 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
348 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
349 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
353 * df invocation:: Report file system space usage
354 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
355 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
356 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
357 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
361 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
362 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
363 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
367 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
368 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
369 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
370 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
372 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
374 * File type tests:: File type tests
375 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
376 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
377 * String tests:: String tests
378 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
380 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
382 * String expressions:: @code{+ : match substr index length}
383 * Numeric expressions:: @code{+ - * / %}
384 * Relations for expr:: @code{| & < <= = == != >= >}
385 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
389 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
391 File name manipulation
393 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
394 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
395 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
396 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
397 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
401 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
402 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
403 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
404 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
406 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
408 * Control:: Control settings
409 * Input:: Input settings
410 * Output:: Output settings
411 * Local:: Local settings
412 * Combination:: Combination settings
413 * Characters:: Special characters
414 * Special:: Special settings
418 * id invocation:: Print user identity
419 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
420 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
421 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
422 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
423 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
427 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
428 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
429 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
430 * uname invocation:: Print system information
431 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
432 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
433 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
435 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
437 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
438 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
439 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
440 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
441 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
442 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
443 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
444 * Examples of date:: Examples
448 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
449 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
451 Modified command invocation
453 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
454 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
455 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
456 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
457 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
458 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
462 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
466 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
470 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
471 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers
472 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
477 * File timestamps:: File timestamp issues
481 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
482 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
483 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
484 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
488 * General date syntax:: Common rules
489 * Calendar date items:: @samp{14 Nov 2022}
490 * Time of day items:: @samp{9:02pm}
491 * Time zone items:: @samp{UTC}, @samp{-0700}, @samp{+0900}, @dots{}
492 * Combined date and time of day items:: @samp{2022-11-14T21:02:42,000000-0500}
493 * Day of week items:: @samp{Monday} and others
494 * Relative items in date strings:: @samp{next tuesday, 2 years ago}
495 * Pure numbers in date strings:: @samp{20221114}, @samp{2102}
496 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @samp{@@1668477762}
497 * Specifying time zone rules:: @samp{TZ="America/New_York"}, @samp{TZ="UTC0"}
498 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
500 Version sorting order
502 * Version sort overview::
503 * Version sort implementation::
504 * Differences from Debian version sort::
505 * Advanced version sort topics::
507 Opening the software toolbox
509 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
510 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
511 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
512 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
513 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
514 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
515 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
519 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
526 @chapter Introduction
528 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
529 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
530 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire GNU community
534 The GNU utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
536 @cindex bugs, reporting
538 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}.
539 Include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
540 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
541 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong.
543 If you have a problem with @command{sort} or @command{date}, try using the
544 @option{--debug} option, as it can often help find and fix problems without
545 having to wait for an answer to a bug report. If the debug output
546 does not suffice to fix the problem on your own, please compress and
547 attach it to the rest of your bug report.
549 Although diffs are welcome,
550 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
551 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
557 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
560 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
561 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
562 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
563 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
564 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
565 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
566 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
567 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
568 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
569 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
570 insights to the overall process.
573 @chapter Common options
577 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
580 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
581 @cindex backups, making
582 @xref{Backup options}.
583 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
586 @macro optBackupSuffix
587 @item -S @var{suffix}
588 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
591 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
592 @xref{Backup options}.
595 @macro optTargetDirectory
596 @item -t @var{directory}
597 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
599 @opindex --target-directory
600 @cindex target directory
601 @cindex destination directory
602 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
603 @xref{Target directory}.
606 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
608 @itemx --no-target-directory
610 @opindex --no-target-directory
611 @cindex target directory
612 @cindex destination directory
613 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
614 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
618 @cindex output NUL-byte-terminated lines
619 Output a zero byte (ASCII NUL) at the end of each line,
620 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
621 output even when that output would contain data with embedded newlines.
640 @macro optZeroTerminated
642 @itemx --zero-terminated
644 @opindex --zero-terminated
645 @cindex process zero-terminated items
646 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (ASCII LF).
647 I.e., treat input as items separated by ASCII NUL
648 and terminate output items with ASCII NUL.
649 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
650 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
651 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
652 or other special characters).
659 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
660 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
661 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
662 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
663 @option{--human-readable} option if
664 you prefer powers of 1024.
667 @macro optHumanReadable
669 @itemx --human-readable
671 @opindex --human-readable
672 @cindex human-readable output
673 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
674 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
675 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
676 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
679 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
680 @item --strip-trailing-slashes
681 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
682 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
683 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
684 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
687 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
688 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
689 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
690 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
691 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
692 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
693 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
698 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
699 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
700 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
702 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
703 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
704 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
705 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
706 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
707 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
708 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
710 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y},
711 @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}.
712 Binary prefixes can be used, too: @samp{KiB}=@samp{K}, @samp{MiB}=@samp{M},
716 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
717 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
718 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
719 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
721 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
722 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
723 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
724 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
725 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
726 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
728 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y},
729 @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}.
730 Binary prefixes can be used, too: @samp{KiB}=@samp{K}, @samp{MiB}=@samp{M},
734 @cindex common options
736 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
737 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
738 described here. (In fact, every GNU program accepts (or should accept)
741 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
742 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
743 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
744 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
745 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
746 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
747 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
749 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
750 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
751 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
752 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
753 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
754 specify a command that itself contains options.
756 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
757 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
758 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
759 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
760 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
762 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
763 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
764 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
771 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
775 @cindex version number, finding
776 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
780 @cindex option delimiter
781 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
782 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
783 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
787 @cindex standard input
788 @cindex standard output
789 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
790 stands for a file operand, and some tools treat it as standard input, or as
791 standard output if that is clear from the context. For example, @samp{sort -}
792 reads from standard input, and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}. Unless
793 otherwise specified, a @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
797 Items shared between some programs:
799 * Backup options:: @option{-b} @option{-S}.
800 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and @option{--block-size}.
801 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals with @option{--signal}.
802 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
803 * Random sources:: @option{--random-source}.
804 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory.
805 * Trailing slashes:: @option{--strip-trailing-slashes}.
806 * Traversing symlinks:: @option{-H}, @option{-L}, or @option{-P}.
807 * Treating / specially:: @option{--preserve-root} and the converse.
808 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
810 Items applicable to all programs:
812 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
813 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
814 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the POSIX standard.
815 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation.
820 @section Backup options
822 @cindex backup options
824 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
825 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
826 before writing new versions.
827 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
828 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
833 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
836 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
837 @cindex backups, making
838 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
839 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
840 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
841 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
842 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
843 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
844 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
846 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
847 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
849 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
850 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
851 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
852 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
853 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
858 @opindex none @r{backup method}
863 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
864 Always make numbered backups.
868 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
869 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
874 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
875 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
876 confused with @samp{none}.
880 @item -S @var{suffix}
881 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
884 @cindex backup suffix
885 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
886 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
887 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
888 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
889 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
898 Some GNU programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
899 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
900 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
901 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
902 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
904 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
907 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
908 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
909 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
910 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
912 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
913 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
918 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
919 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
920 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
923 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
924 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
927 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
928 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
929 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
930 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
931 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
934 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
935 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
936 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
941 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
942 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
943 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
946 @cindex human-readable output
949 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
950 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
951 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
952 that are upward compatible with the
953 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/publications/si-brochure/chapter3.html,
955 for decimal multiples and with the
956 @uref{https://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
957 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
959 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
960 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
961 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
962 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
963 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
966 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
967 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
968 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
969 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
970 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
971 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
974 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
975 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
976 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
977 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
978 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
979 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
980 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
982 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
983 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
984 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
987 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Q}
988 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
992 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
993 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
997 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
998 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
999 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
1000 POSIX use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
1002 @cindex megabyte, definition of
1003 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
1006 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
1007 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
1009 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
1010 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
1013 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
1014 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
1016 @cindex terabyte, definition of
1017 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
1020 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
1021 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
1023 @cindex petabyte, definition of
1024 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
1027 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
1028 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
1030 @cindex exabyte, definition of
1031 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1034 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
1035 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
1037 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
1038 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
1041 zebibyte: @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
1043 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
1044 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1047 yobibyte: @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1049 @cindex ronnabyte, definition of
1050 ronnabyte: @math{10^{27} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1053 robibyte: @math{2^{90} = 1,237,940,039,285,380,274,899,124,224}.
1055 @cindex quettabyte, definition of
1056 quettabyte: @math{10^{30} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1059 quebibyte: @math{2^{100} = 1,267,650,600,228,229,401,496,703,205,376}.
1064 @opindex --block-size
1065 @opindex --human-readable
1068 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1069 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1070 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1071 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1072 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1073 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1074 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}. Note for @command{ls}
1075 the @option{-k} option does not control the display of the
1076 apparent file sizes, whereas the @option{--block-size} option does.
1078 @node Signal specifications
1079 @section Signal specifications
1080 @cindex signals, specifying
1082 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1083 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1084 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1085 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1086 and numbers are supported on all POSIX compliant systems:
1092 2. Terminal interrupt.
1098 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1106 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1107 numbers. All systems conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001 also
1108 support the following signals:
1112 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1114 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1116 Continue executing, if stopped.
1118 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1120 Illegal Instruction.
1122 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1124 Invalid memory reference.
1126 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1130 Background process attempting read.
1132 Background process attempting write.
1134 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1136 User-defined signal 1.
1138 User-defined signal 2.
1142 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XSI extension
1143 also support the following signals:
1149 Profiling timer expired.
1153 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1155 Virtual timer expired.
1157 CPU time limit exceeded.
1159 File size limit exceeded.
1163 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XRT extension
1164 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1165 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1167 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1168 @section chown, chgrp, chroot, id: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1169 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1170 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1171 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1172 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1173 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1175 Since the @var{user} and @var{group} arguments to these commands
1176 may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1178 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1179 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID@?
1180 (Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.)
1181 POSIX requires that these commands
1182 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1183 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID@.
1184 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1185 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1186 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1187 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1188 1000 -- not what you intended.
1190 GNU @command{chown}, @command{chgrp}, @command{chroot}, and @command{id}
1191 provide a way to work around this, that at the same time may result in a
1192 significant performance improvement by eliminating a database look-up.
1193 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1194 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1198 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1202 The name look-up process is skipped for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1203 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1204 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1206 @node Random sources
1207 @section Sources of random data
1209 @cindex random sources
1211 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1212 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1213 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1214 make this selection.
1216 By default these commands use an internal pseudo-random generator
1217 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1218 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1219 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1221 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1222 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1223 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1224 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1225 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1226 cryptographically secure pseudo-random number generator. But be aware
1227 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1228 and is relatively slow.
1230 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1231 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1232 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1233 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1236 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1237 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1238 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1240 Rather than depending on a file, one can generate a reproducible
1241 arbitrary amount of pseudo-random data given a seed value, using
1248 openssl enc -aes-256-ctr -pass pass:"$seed" -nosalt \
1249 </dev/zero 2>/dev/null
1252 shuf -i1-100 --random-source=<(get_seeded_random 42)
1255 @node Target directory
1256 @section Target directory
1258 @cindex target directory
1260 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1261 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1262 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1263 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1264 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1265 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1266 allow more fine-grained control:
1271 @itemx --no-target-directory
1272 @opindex --no-target-directory
1273 @cindex target directory
1274 @cindex destination directory
1275 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1276 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1277 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1278 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1279 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1280 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1281 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1282 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1283 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1285 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1286 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1287 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1289 @item -t @var{directory}
1290 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
1291 @opindex --target-directory
1292 @cindex target directory
1293 @cindex destination directory
1294 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1297 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1298 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1299 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1300 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1301 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1303 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1304 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1305 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1306 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1307 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1308 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1309 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1310 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1313 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1314 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1315 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1316 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1319 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1322 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1323 If you use the GNU @command{find} program, you can move those
1324 files too, with this command:
1327 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1331 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1332 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1333 some other special characters.
1334 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1335 GNU @command{find} and GNU @command{xargs}:
1338 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1339 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1346 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1347 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1348 options cannot be combined.
1350 @node Trailing slashes
1351 @section Trailing slashes
1353 @cindex trailing slashes
1355 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1356 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1357 operating on it. The @option{--strip-trailing-slashes} option enables
1360 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1361 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1362 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1363 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1364 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1365 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1366 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1367 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1368 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1369 be the default, it is required by POSIX and is consistent with
1370 other parts of that standard.
1372 @node Traversing symlinks
1373 @section Traversing symlinks
1375 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1377 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1378 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1379 @c different meaning.
1380 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1381 option is also specified.
1382 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1384 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1385 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1386 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1388 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1389 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1390 a symlink or its referent.
1397 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1398 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1399 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1406 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1407 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1408 that is encountered.
1411 @c Append the following warning to -L where appropriate (e.g. chown).
1412 @macro warnOptDerefWithRec
1414 Combining this dereferencing option with the @option{--recursive} option
1415 may create a security risk:
1416 During the traversal of the directory tree, an attacker may be able to
1417 introduce a symlink to an arbitrary target; when the tool reaches that,
1418 the operation will be performed on the target of that symlink,
1419 possibly allowing the attacker to escalate privileges.
1428 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1429 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1430 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1431 or @option{-P} is specified.
1438 @node Treating / specially
1439 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1441 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1442 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1443 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1444 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1445 legitimate uses for such a command,
1446 GNU @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1447 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1448 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1449 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1450 @option{--preserve-root} option, is safer for most purposes.
1452 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1453 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1454 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1455 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1456 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1457 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1458 interrupt them. Tradition and POSIX require these commands
1459 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1460 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1461 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1462 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1464 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1465 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1466 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1468 @node Special built-in utilities
1469 @section Special built-in utilities
1471 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1472 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1473 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1474 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1475 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1476 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1479 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1480 by POSIX 1003.1-2004.
1483 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1484 return set shift times trap unset}
1487 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1488 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1489 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1491 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1492 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1493 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1494 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1498 @section Exit status
1501 An exit status of zero indicates success,
1502 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
1505 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
1506 that can be used to change how other commands work.
1507 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
1508 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value -- typically
1509 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as POSIX
1510 requires only that it be nonzero.
1512 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
1513 other exit status values and a few associate different
1514 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
1515 Here are the exceptions:
1516 @c You can generate the following list with:
1517 @c grep initialize_exit_failure src/*.c | cut -f1 -d: |
1518 @c sed -n 's|src/\(.*\)\.c|@command{\1},|p' | sort | fmt
1519 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{ls},
1520 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{numfmt}, @command{printenv},
1521 @command{runcon}, @command{sort}, @command{stdbuf}, @command{test},
1522 @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
1524 @node Floating point
1525 @section Floating point numbers
1526 @cindex floating point
1527 @cindex IEEE floating point
1529 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1530 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1531 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1532 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1533 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1534 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1535 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1536 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1537 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1538 @uref{https://@/docs.oracle.com/@/cd/@/E19957-01/@/806-3568/@/ncg_goldberg.html,
1539 What Every Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1541 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1542 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1543 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1544 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1545 @code{-10e100}. Commands that parse floating point also understand
1546 case-insensitive @code{inf}, @code{infinity}, and @code{NaN}, although
1547 whether such values are useful depends on the command in question.
1548 Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal floating point
1549 numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for @minus{}14/16 times
1550 @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. @xref{Parsing of
1551 Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1554 Normally the @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point
1555 character. However, some commands' descriptions specify that they
1556 accept numbers in either the current or the C locale; for example,
1557 they treat @samp{3.14} like @samp{3,14} if the current locale uses
1558 comma as a decimal point.
1561 @node Standards conformance
1562 @section Standards conformance
1564 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1565 In a few cases, the GNU utilities' default behavior is
1566 incompatible with the POSIX standard. To suppress these
1567 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1568 variable. Unless you are checking for POSIX conformance, you
1569 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1571 Newer versions of POSIX are occasionally incompatible with older
1572 versions. For example, older versions of POSIX required the
1573 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1574 fields in each input line, but in POSIX 1003.1-2001
1575 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1576 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1577 sort. To complicate things further, POSIX 1003.1-2008 allows an
1578 implementation to have either the old or the new behavior.
1580 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1581 The GNU utilities normally conform to the version of POSIX
1582 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1583 different version of POSIX, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1584 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1585 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1586 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1587 POSIX 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for POSIX
1588 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for POSIX 1003.1-2008.
1589 For example, if you have a POSIX 1003.1-2001 system but are running software
1590 containing traditional usage like @samp{sort +1} or @samp{tail +10},
1591 you can work around the compatibility problems by setting
1592 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=200809} in your environment.
1594 @c This node is named "Multi-call invocation", not the usual
1595 @c "coreutils invocation", so that shell commands like
1596 @c 'info coreutils "touch invocation"' work as expected.
1597 @node Multi-call invocation
1598 @section @command{coreutils}: Multi-call program
1602 @cindex calling combined multi-call program
1604 The @command{coreutils} command invokes an individual utility, either
1605 implicitly selected by the last component of the name used to invoke
1606 @command{coreutils}, or explicitly with the
1607 @option{--coreutils-prog} option. Synopsis:
1610 coreutils @option{--coreutils-prog=PROGRAM} @dots{}
1613 The @command{coreutils} command is not installed by default, so
1614 portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
1616 @node Output of entire files
1617 @chapter Output of entire files
1619 @cindex output of entire files
1620 @cindex entire files, output of
1622 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1626 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1627 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1628 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1629 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1630 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1631 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1632 * basenc invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1635 @node cat invocation
1636 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1639 @cindex concatenate and write files
1640 @cindex copying files
1642 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1643 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1646 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1649 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1657 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1660 @itemx --number-nonblank
1662 @opindex --number-nonblank
1663 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1667 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1672 @opindex --show-ends
1673 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1674 The @code{\r\n} combination is shown as @samp{^M$}.
1680 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1681 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1684 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1686 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1687 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1688 @cindex squeezing blank lines
1689 Suppress repeated adjacent blank lines; output just one empty line
1694 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1699 @opindex --show-tabs
1700 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1704 Ignored; for POSIX compatibility.
1707 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1709 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1710 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1711 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1716 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1717 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1718 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1719 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1720 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1721 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1722 if standard output is a terminal.
1729 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1732 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1737 @node tac invocation
1738 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1741 @cindex reversing files
1743 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1744 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1745 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1748 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1751 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1752 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1753 the record that it follows in the file.
1755 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1763 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1764 precedes in the file.
1770 Treat the separator string as a regular expression.
1772 @item -s @var{separator}
1773 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1775 @opindex --separator
1776 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1777 Note an empty @var{separator} is treated as a zero byte.
1778 I.e., input and output items are delimited with ASCII NUL.
1782 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1783 @command{tac} reads and writes in binary mode.
1790 # Reverse a file character by character.
1796 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1799 @cindex numbering lines
1800 @cindex line numbering
1802 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1803 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1804 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1807 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1810 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1811 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) page sections;
1812 by default, the line number is reset to 1 at each logical page section.
1813 @command{nl} treats all of the input files as a single document;
1814 it does not reset line numbers or logical pages between files.
1816 @cindex headers, numbering
1817 @cindex body, numbering
1818 @cindex footers, numbering
1819 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1820 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1821 style from the others.
1823 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1824 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1835 The characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1836 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern
1837 of each string cannot be changed.
1839 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1840 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1841 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1842 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1844 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1848 @item -b @var{style}
1849 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1851 @opindex --body-numbering
1852 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1853 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1854 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1855 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1861 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1863 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1865 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1866 expression @var{bre}.
1867 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1871 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1873 @opindex --section-delimiter
1874 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1875 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1876 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1877 As a GNU extension more than two characters can be specified,
1878 and also if @var{cd} is empty (@option{-d ''}), then section
1879 matching is disabled.
1880 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1881 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1883 @item -f @var{style}
1884 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1886 @opindex --footer-numbering
1887 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1889 @item -h @var{style}
1890 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1892 @opindex --header-numbering
1893 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1895 @item -i @var{number}
1896 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1898 @opindex --line-increment
1899 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1900 @var{number} can be negative to decrement.
1902 @item -l @var{number}
1903 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1905 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1906 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1907 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1908 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1909 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1910 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1911 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1914 @item -n @var{format}
1915 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1917 @opindex --number-format
1918 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1922 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1923 left justified, no leading zeros;
1925 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1926 right justified, no leading zeros;
1928 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1929 right justified, leading zeros.
1933 @itemx --no-renumber
1935 @opindex --no-renumber
1936 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1938 @item -s @var{string}
1939 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1941 @opindex --number-separator
1942 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1943 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1945 @item -v @var{number}
1946 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1948 @opindex --starting-line-number
1949 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1950 The starting @var{number} can be negative.
1952 @item -w @var{number}
1953 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1955 @opindex --number-width
1956 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1964 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1967 @cindex octal dump of files
1968 @cindex hex dump of files
1969 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1970 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1972 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1973 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1977 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1978 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1979 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1980 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1983 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1984 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1985 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1986 printed as a single octal number.
1988 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1989 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1990 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1991 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1992 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1993 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1994 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1996 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1997 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1998 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1999 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
2002 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2006 @item -A @var{radix}
2007 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
2009 @opindex --address-radix
2010 @cindex radix for file offsets
2011 @cindex file offset radix
2012 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
2013 be one of the following:
2023 none (do not print offsets).
2026 The default is octal.
2028 @item --endian=@var{order}
2030 @cindex byte-swapping
2032 Reorder input bytes, to handle inputs with differing byte orders,
2033 or to provide consistent output independent of the endian convention
2034 of the current system. Swapping is performed according to the
2035 specified @option{--type} size and endian @var{order}, which can be
2036 @samp{little} or @samp{big}.
2038 @item -j @var{bytes}
2039 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
2041 @opindex --skip-bytes
2042 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
2043 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
2044 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
2046 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
2048 @item -N @var{bytes}
2049 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
2051 @opindex --read-bytes
2052 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
2053 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
2055 @item -S @var{bytes}
2056 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
2059 @cindex string constants, outputting
2060 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
2061 least @var{bytes} consecutive printable characters,
2062 followed by a zero byte (ASCII NUL).
2063 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
2066 If @var{bytes} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
2069 @itemx --format=@var{type}
2072 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
2073 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
2074 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
2075 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
2076 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
2077 in the order that you specified.
2079 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
2080 of the single byte character representation of the printable characters
2081 to the output line generated by the type specification.
2085 named character, ignoring high-order bit
2087 printable single byte character, C backslash escape
2088 or a 3 digit octal sequence
2092 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
2101 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
2102 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
2103 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
2104 Type @code{c} outputs
2105 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
2108 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
2109 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
2110 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
2111 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
2112 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
2113 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
2114 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
2127 For floating point (@code{f}):
2131 @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Bfloat16_floating-point_format,
2134 @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Half-precision_floating-point_format,
2135 half precision float}
2145 @itemx --output-duplicates
2147 @opindex --output-duplicates
2148 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
2149 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
2150 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
2151 indicate the elision.
2154 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
2157 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
2158 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
2161 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
2162 omitted, the default is 32.
2166 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
2167 GNU @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
2168 specification options. These options accumulate.
2174 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
2178 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
2182 Output as printable single byte characters, C backslash escapes
2183 or 3 digit octal sequences. Equivalent to @samp{-t c}.
2187 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2191 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2195 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2199 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2203 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2207 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2211 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2214 @opindex --traditional
2215 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2216 accepted. The following syntax:
2219 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2223 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2224 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2225 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2226 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2227 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2235 @node base32 invocation
2236 @section @command{base32}: Transform data into printable data
2239 @cindex base32 encoding
2241 @command{base32} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2242 into (or from) base32 encoded form. The base32 encoded form uses
2243 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2244 The usage and options of this command are precisely the
2245 same as for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2246 For more general encoding functionality see @ref{basenc invocation}.
2249 @node base64 invocation
2250 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2253 @cindex base64 encoding
2255 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2256 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2257 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2261 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2262 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2265 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2266 The base32 encoding expands data to roughly 160% of the original.
2267 The format conforms to
2268 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc4648/, RFC 4648}.
2270 For more general encoding functionality see @ref{basenc invocation}.
2272 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2277 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2281 @cindex column to wrap data after
2282 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2285 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2286 disable line wrapping altogether.
2292 @cindex Decode base64 data
2293 @cindex Base64 decoding
2294 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2295 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2296 output will be the original data.
2299 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2301 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2302 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2303 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2304 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2305 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2311 @node basenc invocation
2312 @section @command{basenc}: Transform data into printable data
2315 @cindex base32 encoding
2317 @command{basenc} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2318 into (or from) various common encoding forms. The encoded form uses
2319 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2324 basenc @var{encoding} [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2325 basenc @var{encoding} --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2328 The @var{encoding} argument is required. If @var{file} is omitted,
2329 @command{basenc} reads from standard input.
2330 The @option{-w/--wrap},@option{-i/--ignore-garbage},
2331 @option{-d/--decode} options of this command are precisely the same as
2332 for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2335 Supported @var{encoding}s are:
2341 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base64 form.
2342 The format conforms to
2343 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-4, RFC 4648#4}.
2344 Equivalent to the @command{base64} command.
2347 @opindex --base64url
2348 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) file-and-url-safe
2349 base64 form (using @samp{_} and @samp{-} instead of @samp{+} and @samp{/}).
2350 The format conforms to
2351 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-5, RFC 4648#5}.
2355 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base32 form.
2356 The encoded data uses the @samp{ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ234567=} characters.
2357 The format conforms to
2358 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-6, RFC 4648#6}.
2359 Equivalent to the @command{base32} command.
2362 @opindex --base32hex
2363 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) Extended Hex Alphabet
2364 base32 form. The encoded data uses the
2365 @samp{0123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV=} characters. The format conforms to
2366 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-7, RFC 4648#7}.
2370 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base16 (hexadecimal)
2371 form. The encoded data uses the @samp{0123456789ABCDEF} characters. The format
2373 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-8, RFC 4648#8}.
2376 @opindex --base2lsbf
2377 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) binary string form
2378 (@samp{0} and @samp{1}) with the @emph{least} significant bit of every byte
2382 @opindex --base2msbf
2383 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) binary string form
2384 (@samp{0} and @samp{1}) with the @emph{most} significant bit of every byte
2389 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) Z85 form
2390 (a modified Ascii85 form). The encoded data uses the
2391 @samp{0123456789abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTU@
2392 VWXYZ.-:+=^!/*?&<>()[]@{@}@@%$#}.
2393 characters. The format conforms to
2394 @uref{https://rfc.zeromq.org/spec:32/Z85/, ZeroMQ spec:32/Z85}.
2396 When encoding with @option{--z85}, input length must be a multiple of 4;
2397 when decoding with @option{--z85}, input length must be a multiple of 5.
2403 Encoding/decoding examples:
2406 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base64
2409 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base64url
2412 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base32
2415 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base32hex
2418 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base16
2421 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base2lsbf
2422 011111111111001001000001
2424 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base2msbf
2425 111111100100111110000010
2427 $ printf '\376\117\202\000' | basenc --z85
2430 $ printf 01010100 | basenc --base2msbf --decode
2433 $ printf 01010100 | basenc --base2lsbf --decode
2439 @node Formatting file contents
2440 @chapter Formatting file contents
2442 @cindex formatting file contents
2444 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2447 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2448 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2449 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2453 @node fmt invocation
2454 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2457 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2458 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2459 @cindex text, reformatting
2461 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2462 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2465 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2468 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2469 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2471 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2472 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2473 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2476 @cindex line-breaking
2477 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2478 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2479 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2480 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2481 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2482 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2483 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2484 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2485 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2486 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2487 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2488 @cite{Software: Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2491 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2496 @itemx --crown-margin
2498 @opindex --crown-margin
2499 @cindex crown margin
2500 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2501 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2502 line with that of the second line.
2505 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2507 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2508 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2509 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2510 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2511 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2517 @opindex --split-only
2518 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2519 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2520 being unduly combined.
2523 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2525 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2526 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2527 between sentences to two spaces.
2530 @itemx -w @var{width}
2531 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2532 @opindex -@var{width}
2535 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2536 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2539 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2542 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2543 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2545 @item -p @var{prefix}
2546 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2547 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2548 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2549 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2550 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2551 leaving the code unchanged.
2558 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2561 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2562 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2563 @cindex merging files in parallel
2565 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2566 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2567 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2568 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2571 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2575 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2576 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2577 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2578 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2579 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2580 The text line of the header takes the form
2581 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2582 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2583 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2584 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2585 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2586 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2587 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2590 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2591 feeds produce empty pages.
2593 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2594 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2595 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2597 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2598 truncate lines in that case.
2600 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2604 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2605 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2606 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2607 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2608 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2609 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2610 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2611 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2612 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2613 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2614 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2615 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2616 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2617 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2618 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2622 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2623 @opindex -@var{column}
2625 @cindex down columns
2626 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2627 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2628 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2629 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2630 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2631 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2632 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2633 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2634 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2635 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2636 with @option{-m} option.
2642 @cindex across columns
2643 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2644 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2645 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2648 @itemx --show-control-chars
2650 @opindex --show-control-chars
2651 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2652 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2653 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2656 @itemx --double-space
2658 @opindex --double-space
2659 @cindex double spacing
2660 Double space the output.
2662 @item -D @var{format}
2663 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2664 @cindex time formats
2665 @cindex formatting times
2666 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2667 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2668 Except for directives, which start with
2669 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2670 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2671 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2673 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2675 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2676 @samp{2020-07-09 23:59});
2677 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2678 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the POSIX
2679 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2680 @samp{Jul@ @ 9 23:59 2020}.
2683 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2684 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2685 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2686 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2688 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2689 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2691 @opindex --expand-tabs
2693 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2694 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2695 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2703 @opindex --form-feed
2704 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2705 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2707 @item -h @var{header}
2708 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2711 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2712 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2713 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2715 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2716 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2718 @opindex --output-tabs
2720 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2721 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2722 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2728 @opindex --join-lines
2729 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2730 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2731 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2732 no column alignment used; may be used with
2733 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2734 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2735 to disentangle the old (POSIX-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2736 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2739 @item -l @var{page_length}
2740 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2743 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2744 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2745 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2746 @option{-t} option had been given.
2752 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2753 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2754 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2756 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2757 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2758 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2759 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2760 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2761 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2762 the middle blank part.
2764 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2765 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2767 @opindex --number-lines
2768 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2769 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2770 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2771 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2772 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2773 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2774 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2775 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2776 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2777 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2778 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2779 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2780 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2781 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a POSIX specification).
2782 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2783 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2784 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2785 @var{number-separator} TAB@. The tabification depends upon the output
2788 @item -N @var{line_number}
2789 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2791 @opindex --first-line-number
2792 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2793 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2795 @item -o @var{margin}
2796 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2799 @cindex indenting lines
2801 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2802 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2803 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2804 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2807 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2809 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2810 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2811 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2813 @item -s[@var{char}]
2814 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2816 @opindex --separator
2817 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2818 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2819 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2820 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2821 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2822 @option{-w} is set. This is a POSIX-compliant formulation.
2825 @item -S[@var{string}]
2826 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2828 @opindex --sep-string
2829 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2830 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2831 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2832 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2834 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2835 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2836 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2839 @itemx --omit-header
2841 @opindex --omit-header
2842 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2843 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2844 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2845 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2846 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2847 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2848 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2851 @itemx --omit-pagination
2853 @opindex --omit-pagination
2854 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2855 set in the input files.
2858 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2860 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2861 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2863 @item -w @var{page_width}
2864 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2867 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2868 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). The specified
2869 @var{page_width} is rounded down so that columns have equal width.
2870 @option{-s[CHAR]} turns off the default page width and any line truncation
2871 and column alignment.
2872 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2873 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2874 A POSIX-compliant formulation.
2876 @item -W @var{page_width}
2877 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2879 @opindex --page_width
2880 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters, honored with and
2881 without a column option. With a column option, the specified @var{page_width}
2882 is rounded down so that columns have equal width. Text lines are truncated,
2883 unless @option{-J} is used. Together with one of the three column options
2884 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2885 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2886 don't disable the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2887 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2888 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2889 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}@. The header
2890 line is never truncated.
2897 @node fold invocation
2898 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2901 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2902 @cindex folding long input lines
2904 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2905 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2909 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2912 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2913 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2915 @cindex screen columns
2916 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2917 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2918 return sets the column to zero.
2920 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2928 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2929 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2936 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2937 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2938 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2940 @item -w @var{width}
2941 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2944 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2946 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2947 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2955 @node Output of parts of files
2956 @chapter Output of parts of files
2958 @cindex output of parts of files
2959 @cindex parts of files, output of
2961 These commands output pieces of the input.
2964 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2965 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2966 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2967 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2970 @node head invocation
2971 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2974 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2975 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2977 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2978 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2979 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2982 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2985 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2986 one-line header consisting of:
2989 ==> @var{file name} <==
2993 before the output for each @var{file}.
2995 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2999 @item -c [-]@var{num}
3000 @itemx --bytes=[-]@var{num}
3003 Print the first @var{num} bytes, instead of initial lines.
3004 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
3005 print all but the last @var{num} bytes of each file.
3006 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
3008 @item -n [-]@var{num}
3009 @itemx --lines=[-]@var{num}
3012 Output the first @var{num} lines.
3013 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
3014 print all but the last @var{num} lines of each file.
3015 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3023 Never print file name headers.
3029 Always print file name headers.
3035 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
3036 @option{-[@var{num}][bkm][cqv]}, which is recognized only if it is
3037 specified first. @var{num} is a decimal number optionally followed
3038 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
3039 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
3040 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{num}}
3041 or @option{-n @var{num}} instead. If your script must also run on
3042 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
3043 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
3049 @node tail invocation
3050 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
3053 @cindex last part of files, outputting
3055 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
3056 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
3057 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3060 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3063 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
3064 one-line header before the output for each @var{file}, consisting of:
3067 ==> @var{file name} <==
3070 For further processing of tail output, it can be useful to convert the
3071 file headers to line prefixes, which can be done like:
3076 /^==> .* <==$/ @{prefix=substr($0,5,length-8)":"; next@}
3081 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
3082 GNU @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
3083 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
3084 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
3085 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
3086 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
3087 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
3088 the GNU @command{tac} command.
3090 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3094 @item -c [+]@var{num}
3095 @itemx --bytes=[+]@var{num}
3098 Output the last @var{num} bytes, instead of final lines.
3099 If @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
3100 byte @var{num} from the start of each file. For example to skip the first byte
3101 use @code{tail -c +2}, while to skip all but the last byte use @code{tail -c 1}.
3102 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
3105 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
3108 @cindex growing files
3109 @vindex name @r{follow option}
3110 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
3111 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
3112 presumably because the file is growing.
3113 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
3114 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
3117 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
3118 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
3120 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
3121 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
3122 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
3123 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
3124 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
3125 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
3126 Note that the inotify-based implementation handles this case without
3127 the need for any periodic reopening.
3129 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
3130 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
3131 and resumes tracking from the start of the file, assuming it has been
3132 truncated to 0, which is the usual truncation operation for log files.
3134 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
3135 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
3136 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
3137 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
3138 periodically to see if the file reappears.
3139 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
3140 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
3141 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
3144 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
3145 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
3147 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
3148 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
3149 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
3150 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
3152 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
3153 and is generally very prompt.
3154 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks --
3155 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default -- which can
3156 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
3157 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
3158 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
3161 alias tail='tail -s.1'
3166 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
3167 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
3168 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
3170 @item --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
3171 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
3172 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
3173 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
3174 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
3175 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
3176 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
3177 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
3178 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
3179 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
3180 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
3181 and when following by name.
3183 @item -n [+]@var{num}
3184 @itemx --lines=[+]@var{}
3187 Output the last @var{num} lines.
3188 If @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
3189 line @var{num} from the start of each file. For example to skip the first line
3190 use @code{tail -n +2}, while to skip all but the last line use @code{tail -n 1}.
3191 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3193 @item --pid=@var{pid}
3195 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
3196 @var{pid}, of one or more (by repeating @option{--pid}) writers of the
3197 @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly after all the identified
3198 processes terminate, tail will also terminate. This will
3199 work properly only if the writers and the tailing process are running on
3200 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
3201 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
3202 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
3203 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
3207 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
3210 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
3211 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
3212 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
3213 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
3214 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
3215 will print a warning if this is the case.
3223 Never print file name headers.
3227 Indefinitely try to open the specified file.
3228 This option is useful mainly when following (and otherwise issues a warning).
3230 When following by file descriptor (i.e., with @option{--follow=descriptor}),
3231 this option only affects the initial open of the file, as after a successful
3232 open, @command{tail} will start following the file descriptor.
3234 When following by name (i.e., with @option{--follow=name}), @command{tail}
3235 infinitely retries to re-open the given files until killed.
3237 Without this option, when @command{tail} encounters a file that doesn't
3238 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
3239 never checks it again.
3241 @item -s @var{number}
3242 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
3244 @opindex --sleep-interval
3245 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
3246 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
3248 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
3249 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
3250 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
3251 every @var{number} seconds.
3252 The @var{number} must be non-negative and can be a floating-point number
3253 in either the current or the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
3259 Always print file name headers.
3265 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
3266 @samp{tail -[@var{num}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
3267 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
3268 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
3269 file. In the option, @var{num} is an optional decimal number optionally
3270 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
3271 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
3272 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
3274 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3275 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001, the leading @samp{-}
3276 can be replaced by @samp{+} in the traditional option syntax with the
3277 same meaning as in counts, and on obsolete systems predating POSIX
3278 1003.1-2001 traditional usage overrides normal usage when the two
3279 conflict. This behavior can be controlled with the
3280 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3283 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
3284 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{num}[b]}, @option{-n
3285 @var{num}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
3286 run on hosts that support only the traditional syntax, you can often
3287 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
3288 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
3289 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
3290 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
3292 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
3293 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the POSIX
3294 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
3295 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
3296 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
3297 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
3298 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
3303 @node split invocation
3304 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
3307 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
3308 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
3310 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
3311 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
3312 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3315 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
3318 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
3319 left over for the last section), into each output file.
3321 @cindex output file name prefix
3322 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
3323 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
3324 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
3325 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
3326 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3327 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3328 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3329 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3330 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3331 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3332 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3333 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3334 output files that it did create.
3336 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3340 @item -l @var{lines}
3341 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3344 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3345 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3346 the number of records.
3348 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3349 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3350 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3353 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3356 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3357 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3360 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3362 @opindex --line-bytes
3363 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3364 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines or records
3365 longer than @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3366 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3367 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3368 the number of records.
3370 @item --filter=@var{command}
3372 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3373 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3374 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3375 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3376 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3377 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on secondary storage,
3378 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3379 of a more manageable size.
3380 To do that, you might run this command:
3383 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3386 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3387 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3389 @item -n @var{chunks}
3390 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3394 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3397 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3398 @var{k}/@var{n} output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to standard output
3399 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines or records
3400 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3401 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3402 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3405 If the input size is not a multiple of @var{n}, early output files are
3406 one byte longer than later output files, to make up the difference.
3407 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3408 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3410 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3411 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3413 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3414 Although the @var{input} is still partitioned as before into @var{n} regions
3415 of approximately equal size, if a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3416 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines or records
3417 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3418 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3419 if a line/record is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3421 When the input is a pipe or some other special file where the size
3422 cannot easily be determined, there is no trouble for @samp{r} mode
3423 because the size of the input is irrelevant. For other modes, such an
3424 input is first copied to a temporary to determine its size.
3426 @item -a @var{length}
3427 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3429 @opindex --suffix-length
3430 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3431 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3432 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3433 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3434 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3437 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3439 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3440 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3441 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3443 @var{from} is supported with the long form option, and is used to either set the
3444 initial suffix for a single run, or to set the suffix offset for independently
3445 split inputs, and consequently the auto suffix length expansion described above
3446 is disabled. Therefore you may also want to use option @option{-a} to allow
3447 suffixes beyond @samp{99}. Note if option @option{--number} is specified and
3448 the number of files is less than @var{from}, a single run is assumed and the
3449 minimum suffix length required is automatically determined.
3452 @itemx --hex-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3454 @opindex --hex-suffixes
3455 Like @option{--numeric-suffixes}, but use hexadecimal numbers (in lower case).
3457 @item --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3458 @opindex --additional-suffix
3459 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3460 must not contain slash.
3463 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3465 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3466 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3467 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3468 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3469 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3470 even when this option is specified.
3472 @item -t @var{separator}
3473 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
3475 @opindex --separator
3476 @cindex line separator character
3477 @cindex record separator character
3478 Use character @var{separator} as the record separator instead of the default
3479 newline character (ASCII LF).
3480 To specify ASCII NUL as the separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0},
3481 e.g., @samp{split -t '\0'}.
3486 @opindex --unbuffered
3487 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/@dots{}} mode,
3488 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3492 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3498 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3499 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3501 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3504 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3517 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3520 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3533 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3536 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3549 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3550 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3553 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3560 @node csplit invocation
3561 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3564 @cindex context splitting
3565 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3567 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3568 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3571 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3574 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3575 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3576 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3577 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3578 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3581 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3582 output file after it has been created.
3584 The types of pattern arguments are:
3589 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3590 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3591 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3592 file once for each repeat.
3594 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3595 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3596 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3597 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer, that can
3598 be preceded by @samp{+} or @samp{-}.
3599 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3600 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3601 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3602 Note lines within a negative offset of a regexp pattern
3603 are not matched in subsequent regexp patterns.
3605 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3606 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3607 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3609 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3610 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3611 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3612 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3617 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3618 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3619 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3620 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3621 original input file, excluding portions skipped with a %@var{regexp}%
3622 pattern or the @option{--suppress-matched} option.
3624 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3625 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3626 that it has created so far before it exits.
3628 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3632 @item -f @var{prefix}
3633 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3636 @cindex output file name prefix
3637 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3639 @item -b @var{format}
3640 @itemx --suffix-format=@var{format}
3642 @opindex --suffix-format
3643 @cindex output file name suffix
3644 Use @var{format} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3645 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3646 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3647 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specification,
3648 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3649 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3650 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3651 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3652 entire @var{format} is given (with the current output file number) to
3653 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3654 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3655 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3657 @item -n @var{digits}
3658 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3661 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3662 long instead of the default 2.
3667 @opindex --keep-files
3668 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3670 @item --suppress-matched
3671 @opindex --suppress-matched
3672 Do not output lines matching the specified @var{pattern}.
3673 I.e., suppress the boundary line from the start of the second
3674 and subsequent splits.
3677 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3679 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3680 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3681 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3682 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3683 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3684 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3695 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3701 Here is an example of its usage.
3702 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3709 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3712 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3718 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3719 file that csplit has just created.
3720 List the names of those output files:
3727 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3752 Example of splitting input by empty lines:
3755 $ csplit --suppress-matched @var{input.txt} '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3759 @c TODO: "uniq" already supports "--group".
3760 @c when it gets the "--key" option, uncomment this example.
3762 @c Example of splitting input file, based on the value of column 2:
3765 @c $ cat @var{input.txt} |
3767 @c uniq --group -k2,2 |
3768 @c csplit -m '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3771 @node Summarizing files
3772 @chapter Summarizing files
3774 @cindex summarizing files
3776 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3780 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3781 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3782 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3783 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3784 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
3785 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3786 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3791 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3795 @cindex character count
3799 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, words, and newlines
3800 in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given
3801 or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. A word is a nonempty sequence of non white
3802 space delimited by white space characters or by start or end of input.
3806 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3809 @cindex total counts
3810 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3811 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. By default
3812 if more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3813 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}.
3814 This @samp{total} line can be controlled with the @option{--total} option,
3815 which is a GNU extension.
3816 The counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3817 maximum line length.
3818 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3819 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3820 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3821 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3822 However, as a GNU extension, if only one count is printed,
3823 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3825 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3826 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3827 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3834 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3836 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3837 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3838 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3839 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3840 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3842 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3850 Print only the byte counts.
3856 Print only the character counts, as per the current locale.
3857 Encoding errors are not counted.
3863 Print only the word counts. A word is a nonempty sequence of non white
3864 space delimited by white space characters or by start or end of input.
3865 The current locale determines which characters are white space.
3866 GNU @command{wc} treats encoding errors as non white space.
3868 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3869 Unless the environment variable @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set,
3870 GNU @command{wc} treats the following Unicode characters as white
3871 space even if the current locale does not: U+00A0 NO-BREAK SPACE,
3872 U+2007 FIGURE SPACE, U+202F NARROW NO-BREAK SPACE, and U+2060 WORD
3879 Print only the newline character counts.
3880 Note a file without a trailing newline character,
3881 will not have that last portion included in the line count.
3884 @itemx --max-line-length
3886 @opindex --max-line-length
3887 Print only the maximum display widths.
3888 Tabs are set at every 8th column.
3889 Display widths of wide characters are considered.
3890 Non-printable characters are given 0 width.
3892 @item --total=@var{when}
3893 @opindex --total=@var{when}
3894 Control when and how the final line with cumulative counts is printed.
3895 @var{when} is one of:
3898 @vindex auto @r{total option}
3899 - This is the default mode of @command{wc} when no @option{--total}
3900 option is specified. Output a total line if more than one @var{file}
3903 @vindex always @r{total option}
3904 - Always output a total line, irrespective of the number of files processed.
3906 @vindex only @r{total option}
3907 - Only output total counts. I.e., don't print individual file counts,
3908 suppress any leading spaces, and don't print the @samp{total} word itself,
3909 to simplify subsequent processing.
3911 @vindex none @r{total option}
3912 - Never output a total line.
3915 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3916 @item --files0-from=@var{file}
3917 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3918 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3919 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3920 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3921 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3922 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3924 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3925 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3927 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3928 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3929 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3930 One way to produce a list of ASCII NUL terminated file
3932 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3933 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the ASCII NUL terminated
3934 file names are read from standard input.
3936 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3938 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3939 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3942 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3943 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3951 @node sum invocation
3952 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3955 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3956 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3958 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3959 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3962 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3965 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3966 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If at least one @var{file}
3967 is given, file names are also printed.
3969 By default, GNU @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3970 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3973 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3979 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3980 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3981 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3982 given, it has no effect.
3988 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3989 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3990 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3994 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3995 next section) is preferable in new applications.
4000 @node cksum invocation
4001 @section @command{cksum}: Print and verify file checksums
4004 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
4005 @cindex CRC checksum
4006 @cindex 32-bit checksum
4007 @cindex checksum, 32-bit
4010 @command{cksum} by default computes a 32-bit cyclic redundancy check (CRC)
4011 checksum for each given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for
4012 a @var{file} of @samp{-}.
4014 cksum also supports the @option{-a/--algorithm} option to select the
4015 digest algorithm to use. @command{cksum} is the preferred interface
4016 to these digests, subsuming the other standalone checksumming utilities,
4017 which can be emulated using @code{cksum -a md5 --untagged "$@@"} etc.
4021 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4024 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files have not been corrupted,
4025 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
4026 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
4030 * cksum output modes:: Legacy and non Legacy output formats
4031 * cksum general options:: Options supported only by cksum
4032 * cksum common options:: Options supported also by standalone utilities
4035 @node cksum output modes
4036 @subsection cksum output modes
4040 @item Legacy output format
4041 @command{cksum} by default prints the POSIX standard CRC checksum
4042 for each file along with the number of bytes in the file,
4043 and the file name unless no arguments were given.
4044 The 32-bit CRC used is based on the polynomial used
4045 for CRC error checking in the ISO/IEC 8802-3:1996 standard (Ethernet).
4046 Similar output formats are used for the other legacy checksums
4047 selectable with @option{--algorithm=sysv} or @option{--algorithm=bsd},
4048 detailed at @ref{sum invocation}.
4050 @item Tagged output format
4051 With the @option{--algorithm} option selecting non legacy checksums,
4052 the @command{cksum} command defaults to output of the form:
4054 @var{digest_name} (@var{file name}) = @var{digest}
4056 Note the standalone checksum utilities can select this output
4057 mode by using the @option{--tag} option.
4059 @item Untagged output format
4060 With the @option{--untagged} option and the @option{--algorithm} option
4061 selecting non legacy checksums, the following output format is used.
4062 Note this is the default output format of the standalone checksum utilities.
4063 For each @var{file}, we print the checksum, a space, a flag indicating
4064 binary or text input mode, and the file name.
4065 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text mode with @samp{ } (space).
4066 Binary mode is the default on systems where it's significant,
4067 otherwise text mode is the default.
4071 Note without @option{--zero}, and with non legacy output formats,
4072 if @var{file} contains a backslash, newline, or carriage return,
4073 the line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character
4074 in the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output unambiguous
4075 even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
4076 Since the backslash character itself is escaped, any other backslash
4077 escape sequences are reserved for future use.
4079 @node cksum general options
4080 @subsection cksum general options
4087 @opindex --algorithm
4088 @cindex digest algorithm
4089 Compute checksums using the specified digest algorithm.
4091 Supported legacy checksums (which are not supported by @option{--check}):
4093 @samp{sysv} equivalent to @command{sum -s}
4094 @samp{bsd} equivalent to @command{sum -r}
4095 @samp{crc} equivalent to @command{cksum} (the default)
4098 Supported more modern digest algorithms are:
4100 @samp{md5} equivalent to @command{md5sum}
4101 @samp{sha1} equivalent to @command{sha1sum}
4102 @samp{sha224} equivalent to @command{sha224sum}
4103 @samp{sha256} equivalent to @command{sha256sum}
4104 @samp{sha384} equivalent to @command{sha384sum}
4105 @samp{sha512} equivalent to @command{sha512sum}
4106 @samp{blake2b} equivalent to @command{b2sum}
4107 @samp{sm3} only available through @command{cksum}
4112 @cindex base64 checksum encoding
4113 Print base64-encoded digests not hexadecimal.
4114 This option is ignored with @option{--check}.
4115 The format conforms to
4116 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-4, RFC 4648#4}.
4118 Note that each base64-encoded digest has zero, one or two trailing padding
4119 (@samp{=}) bytes. The length of that padding is the checksum-bit-length
4120 modulo 3, and the @option{--check} parser requires precisely the same
4121 input digest string as what is output. I.e., removing or adding any
4122 @samp{=} padding renders a digest non-matching.
4126 Output extra information to stderr, like the checksum implementation being used.
4128 @macro cksumLengthOption
4133 @cindex BLAKE2 hash length
4134 Change (shorten) the default digest length.
4135 This is specified in bits and thus must be a multiple of 8.
4136 This option is ignored when @option{--check} is specified,
4137 as the length is automatically determined when checking.
4143 @cindex raw binary checksum
4144 Print only the unencoded raw binary digest for a single input.
4145 Do not output the file name or anything else.
4146 Use network byte order (big endian) where applicable:
4147 for @samp{bsd}, @samp{crc}, and @samp{sysv}.
4148 This option works only with a single input.
4149 Unlike other output formats, @command{cksum} provides no way to
4150 @option{--check} a @option{--raw} checksum.
4154 Output using the original Coreutils format used by the other
4155 standalone checksum utilities like @command{md5sum} for example.
4156 This format has the checksum at the start of the line, and may be
4157 more amenable to further processing by other utilities,
4158 especially in combination with the @option{--zero} option.
4159 Note this does not identify the digest algorithm used for the checksum.
4160 @xref{cksum output modes} for details of this format.
4163 @node cksum common options
4164 @subsection cksum common options
4172 @cindex binary input files
4173 Note this option is not supported by the @command{cksum} command,
4174 as it operates in binary mode exclusively.
4175 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
4176 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
4177 On systems like GNU that do not distinguish between binary
4178 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
4179 the checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
4180 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
4181 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
4185 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
4186 @var{file} (or from standard input if no @var{file} was specified) and report
4187 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
4188 The input to this mode is usually the output of
4189 a prior, checksum-generating run of the command.
4191 Three input formats are supported. Either the default output
4192 format described above, the @option{--tag} output format,
4193 or the BSD reversed mode format which is similar to the default mode,
4194 but doesn't use a character to distinguish binary and text modes.
4196 For the @command{cksum} command, the @option{--check} option
4197 supports auto-detecting the digest algorithm to use,
4198 when presented with checksum information in the @option{--tag} output format.
4200 Also for the @command{cksum} command, the @option{--check} option
4201 auto-detects the digest encoding, accepting both standard hexadecimal
4202 checksums and those generated via @command{cksum} with its
4203 @option{--base64} option.
4205 Output with @option{--zero} enabled is not supported by @option{--check}.
4207 For each such line, @command{cksum} reads the named file and computes its
4208 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
4209 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
4210 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
4211 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
4212 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
4213 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
4214 a warning is issued to standard error.
4215 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
4216 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
4217 a checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
4218 line is found, @command{cksum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
4219 it exits successfully.
4220 Note the @command{cksum} command doesn't support @option{--check}
4221 with the older @samp{sysv}, @samp{bsd}, or @samp{crc} algorithms.
4223 @item --ignore-missing
4224 @opindex --ignore-missing
4225 @cindex verifying checksums
4226 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4227 When verifying checksums, don't fail or report any status
4228 for missing files. This is useful when verifying a subset
4229 of downloaded files given a larger list of checksums.
4233 @cindex verifying checksums
4234 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4235 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
4236 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
4237 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
4238 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
4242 @cindex verifying checksums
4243 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4244 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
4245 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
4246 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
4248 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
4249 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
4250 indicating there was a failure.
4255 Output BSD style checksums, which indicate the checksum algorithm used.
4256 As a GNU extension, if @option{--zero} is not used, file names with problematic
4257 characters are escaped as described above, using the same escaping indicator of
4258 @samp{\} at the start of the line, as used with the other output format.
4259 The @option{--tag} option implies binary mode, and is disallowed with
4260 @option{--text} mode as supporting that would unnecessarily complicate
4261 the output format, while providing little benefit.
4262 @xref{cksum output modes} for details of this format.
4263 The @command{cksum} command, uses @option{--tag} as its default output format.
4269 @cindex text input files
4270 Note this option is not supported by the @command{cksum} command.
4271 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
4272 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
4273 This option is the default on systems like GNU that do not
4274 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
4275 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
4276 terminal. This mode is never defaulted to if @option{--tag} is used.
4282 @cindex verifying checksums
4283 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted checksum lines.
4284 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
4289 @cindex verifying checksums
4290 When verifying checksums,
4291 if one or more input line is invalid,
4292 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
4295 Also file name escaping is not used.
4298 @node md5sum invocation
4299 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
4303 @cindex 128-bit checksum
4304 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
4305 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
4306 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
4308 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
4309 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
4311 @macro weakHash{hash}
4312 Note: The \hash\ digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
4313 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
4314 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical \hash\
4315 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
4316 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given \hash\
4317 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
4318 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
4319 appear valid when signed with an \hash\ digest. For more secure hashes,
4320 consider using SHA-2, or the newer @command{b2sum} command.
4321 @xref{sha2 utilities}. @xref{b2sum invocation}.
4325 @macro checksumUsage{command}
4326 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
4327 @command{\command\} computes the checksum for the standard input.
4328 @command{\command\} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
4329 consistent. Synopsis:
4332 \command\ [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4335 @command{\command\} uses the @samp{Untagged output format}
4336 for each specified file, as described at @ref{cksum output modes}.
4338 The program accepts @ref{cksum common options}. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4340 @checksumUsage{md5sum}
4345 @node b2sum invocation
4346 @section @command{b2sum}: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
4350 @cindex 512-bit checksum
4351 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4352 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4353 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4355 @command{b2sum} computes a 512-bit checksum for each specified
4358 @checksumUsage{b2sum}
4360 In addition @command{b2sum} supports the following options.
4367 @node sha1sum invocation
4368 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
4372 @cindex 160-bit checksum
4373 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
4374 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
4375 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
4377 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified @var{file}.
4381 @checksumUsage{sha1sum}
4383 @node sha2 utilities
4384 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
4391 @cindex 224-bit checksum
4392 @cindex 256-bit checksum
4393 @cindex 384-bit checksum
4394 @cindex 512-bit checksum
4395 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
4396 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
4397 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
4398 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4399 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
4400 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
4401 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
4402 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4403 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
4404 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
4405 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
4406 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4408 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
4409 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
4410 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
4411 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes.
4413 @checksumUsage{sha???sum}
4416 @node Operating on sorted files
4417 @chapter Operating on sorted files
4419 @cindex operating on sorted files
4420 @cindex sorted files, operations on
4422 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
4425 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
4426 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
4427 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
4428 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
4429 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
4430 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
4434 @node sort invocation
4435 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
4438 @cindex sorting files
4440 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
4441 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
4442 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
4446 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4449 @cindex sort stability
4450 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4451 Many options affect how @command{sort} compares lines; if the results
4452 are unexpected, try the @option{--debug} option to see what happened.
4453 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
4454 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields (see @option{--key}), in the
4455 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
4456 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
4457 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
4458 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
4459 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
4460 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
4461 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
4462 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
4463 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
4464 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
4468 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
4469 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
4470 use a non-POSIX locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
4471 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
4472 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
4473 environment variable to @samp{C}@. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
4474 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
4475 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
4476 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
4477 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
4478 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
4479 A line's trailing newline is not part of the line for comparison
4480 purposes. If the final byte of an input file is not a newline, GNU
4481 @command{sort} silently supplies one. GNU @command{sort} (as
4482 specified for all GNU utilities) has no limit on input line length or
4483 restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
4485 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
4486 and check for order. The following options change the operation
4493 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
4496 @cindex checking whether a file is sorted
4497 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
4498 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
4499 exit with a status of 1.
4500 Otherwise, exit successfully.
4501 At most one input file can be given.
4504 @itemx --check=quiet
4505 @itemx --check=silent
4508 @cindex checking whether a file is sorted
4509 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
4510 exit with status 1 otherwise.
4511 At most one input file can be given.
4512 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
4518 @cindex merging sorted files
4519 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
4520 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
4521 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
4526 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
4530 0 if no error occurred
4531 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
4532 2 if an error occurred
4536 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
4537 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
4538 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
4539 the environment variable.
4541 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
4542 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
4543 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
4544 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
4545 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-POSIX
4546 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
4547 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
4552 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
4554 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
4555 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
4557 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
4558 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4559 can change this. Note blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
4560 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
4561 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
4564 @itemx --dictionary-order
4566 @opindex --dictionary-order
4567 @cindex dictionary order
4568 @cindex phone directory order
4569 @cindex telephone directory order
4571 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
4572 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
4573 By default letters and digits are those of ASCII and a blank
4574 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
4577 @itemx --ignore-case
4579 @opindex --ignore-case
4580 @cindex ignoring case
4581 @cindex case folding
4583 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
4584 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
4585 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4586 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
4587 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
4588 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
4589 the final result, after the throwing away.))
4592 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
4593 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
4595 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
4597 @cindex general numeric sort
4599 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
4600 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
4601 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
4602 Use the following collating sequence:
4606 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
4608 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
4609 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
4613 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4618 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4619 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4620 converting to floating point.
4622 You can use this option to sort hexadecimal numbers prefixed with
4623 @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, where those numbers are not fixed width,
4624 or of varying case. However for hex numbers of consistent case,
4625 and left padded with @samp{0} to a consistent width, a standard
4626 lexicographic sort will be faster.
4629 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4630 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4632 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4634 @cindex human numeric sort
4636 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4637 then by SI suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4638 one of @samp{MGTPEZYRQ}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4639 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4640 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an SI
4641 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4642 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4643 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4644 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4645 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4646 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4647 option; the SI suffix must immediately follow the number.
4648 Note also the @command{numfmt} command, which can be used to reformat
4649 numbers to human format @emph{after} the sort, thus often allowing
4650 sort to operate on more accurate numbers.
4653 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4655 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4656 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4657 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4659 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4660 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4661 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4662 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4668 @opindex --month-sort
4670 @cindex months, sorting by
4672 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4673 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4674 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}@.
4675 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4676 category determines the month spellings.
4677 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4681 @itemx --numeric-sort
4682 @itemx --sort=numeric
4684 @opindex --numeric-sort
4686 @cindex numeric sort
4689 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4690 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4691 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4692 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4693 number is treated as @samp{0}. Signs on zeros and leading zeros do
4694 not affect ordering.
4696 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4698 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale specifies which characters are blanks and
4699 the @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale specifies the thousands separator and
4700 decimal-point character. In the C locale, spaces and tabs are blanks,
4701 there is no thousands separator, and @samp{.} is the decimal point.
4703 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4704 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4705 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4708 @itemx --version-sort
4710 @opindex --version-sort
4711 @cindex version number sort
4712 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4713 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4714 as an index/version number. (@xref{Version sort ordering}.)
4720 @cindex reverse sorting
4721 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4722 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4725 @itemx --random-sort
4726 @itemx --sort=random
4728 @opindex --random-sort
4731 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4732 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4733 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4734 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4735 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4737 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4738 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4739 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4742 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4743 @option{--random-source} option.
4751 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4752 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4754 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4755 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4756 standard input to standard output.
4758 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4760 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4761 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4763 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4765 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4766 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4770 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4771 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4772 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4774 In its simplest form @var{pos} specifies a field number (starting with 1),
4775 with fields being separated by runs of blank characters, and by default
4776 those blanks being included in the comparison at the start of each field.
4777 To adjust the handling of blank characters see the @option{-b} and
4778 @option{-t} options.
4781 each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4782 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4783 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4784 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4785 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4786 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4787 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4788 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4789 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4792 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4793 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4794 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4795 of the line being used in the sort.
4798 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4799 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to standard error.
4801 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4802 @opindex --batch-size
4803 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4804 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4806 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4807 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4808 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4810 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4811 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4812 and I/O@. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4813 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4816 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4817 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4820 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4821 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4822 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4823 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4824 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4825 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4826 silently uses a smaller value.
4828 @item -o @var{output-file}
4829 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4832 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4833 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4834 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4835 @var{output-file}, so you can sort a file in place by using
4836 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}@.
4837 However, it is often safer to output to an otherwise-unused file, as
4838 data may be lost if the system crashes or @command{sort} encounters
4839 an I/O or other serious error while a file is being sorted in place.
4840 Also, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4841 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4842 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4843 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4845 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4846 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4847 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}@. Portable
4848 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4851 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4852 @opindex --random-source
4853 @cindex random source for sorting
4854 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4855 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4862 @cindex sort stability
4863 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4865 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4866 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4867 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4870 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4872 @opindex --buffer-size
4873 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4874 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4875 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4876 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4877 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4878 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4879 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y}, @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}@.
4881 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4884 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4885 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4886 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4887 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4890 @item -t @var{separator}
4891 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4893 @opindex --field-separator
4894 @cindex field separator character
4895 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4896 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4897 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4898 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4901 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4902 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4903 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4904 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4905 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4906 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4907 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4908 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4910 To specify ASCII NUL as the field separator,
4911 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4913 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4914 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4916 @opindex --temporary-directory
4917 @cindex temporary directory
4919 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4920 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4921 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4922 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4923 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4926 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4928 @cindex multithreaded sort
4929 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4930 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4931 to 8, as there are diminishing performance gains after that.
4932 Note also that using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4933 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4939 @cindex uniquifying output
4941 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4942 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4943 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4945 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4947 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4948 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4949 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4950 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4951 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4954 @macro newlineFieldSeparator
4955 Note with @option{-z} the newline character is treated as a field separator.
4960 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4961 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4962 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4963 GNU sort follows the POSIX
4964 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4965 According to POSIX, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4966 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4967 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4968 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4970 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4971 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4972 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4973 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4974 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4975 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4976 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4977 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4978 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4979 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4981 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4982 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4983 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4984 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4986 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4987 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4988 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
4989 @command{sort} supports a traditional origin-zero
4990 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4991 The traditional command @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4992 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4993 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4994 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4996 This traditional behavior can be controlled with the
4997 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4998 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4999 not set by using the traditional syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
5001 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
5002 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
5003 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
5004 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
5005 support only the traditional syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
5006 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
5009 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
5014 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
5021 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
5024 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
5028 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
5029 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
5030 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
5031 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
5032 and extending to the end of each line.
5039 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
5040 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
5041 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
5044 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
5047 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
5048 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
5049 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
5050 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
5051 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
5053 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
5054 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
5055 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
5056 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
5057 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
5058 field-end part of the key specifier.
5061 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
5062 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
5063 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
5067 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
5068 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
5069 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
5072 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
5073 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
5074 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
5075 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
5076 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
5077 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
5078 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
5082 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
5083 timestamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
5084 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
5085 files contain lines that look like this:
5088 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2020:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
5089 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2020:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
5092 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
5093 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
5094 because 61 is less than 129.
5097 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
5098 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
5101 This example cannot be done with a single POSIX @command{sort} invocation,
5102 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
5103 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
5104 @command{sort}: the first sorts by timestamp and the second by IPv4
5105 address. The timestamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
5106 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
5107 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
5108 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
5109 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
5110 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
5111 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
5112 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
5113 sorts is stable. Note as a GNU extension, the above example could
5114 be achieved in a single @command{sort} invocation by sorting the
5115 IPv4 address field using a @samp{V} version type, like @samp{-k1,1V}.
5118 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
5121 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
5124 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
5125 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
5127 by the sort operation.
5129 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
5131 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
5132 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0},
5133 @c then using sort's @option{-z} option,
5134 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
5137 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
5138 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
5140 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
5144 Use the common DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate idiom to
5145 sort lines according to their length.
5148 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
5151 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
5152 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
5155 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
5156 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
5157 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
5161 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
5167 @node shuf invocation
5168 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
5171 @cindex shuffling files
5173 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
5174 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
5178 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
5179 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
5180 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
5183 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
5184 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
5185 input. The following options change the operation mode:
5193 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
5194 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
5196 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
5197 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
5199 @opindex --input-range
5200 @cindex input range to shuffle
5201 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
5202 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
5206 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
5211 @item -n @var{count}
5212 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
5214 @opindex --head-count
5215 @cindex head of output
5216 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
5219 @item -o @var{output-file}
5220 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
5223 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
5224 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
5225 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
5226 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
5227 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
5229 @item --random-source=@var{file}
5230 @opindex --random-source
5231 @cindex random source for shuffling
5232 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
5233 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
5239 @cindex repeat output values
5240 Repeat output values, that is, select with replacement. With this
5241 option the output is not a permutation of the input; instead, each
5242 output line is randomly chosen from all the inputs. This option is
5243 typically combined with @option{--head-count}; if
5244 @option{--head-count} is not given, @command{shuf} repeats
5263 might produce the output
5273 Similarly, the command:
5276 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
5290 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
5300 The above examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
5301 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
5302 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
5303 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
5304 output permutations.
5307 To output 50 random numbers each in the range 0 through 9, use:
5310 shuf -r -n 50 -i 0-9
5314 To simulate 100 coin flips, use:
5317 shuf -r -n 100 -e Head Tail
5323 @node uniq invocation
5324 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
5327 @cindex uniquify files
5329 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
5330 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
5334 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5337 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
5338 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
5339 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
5340 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
5342 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
5343 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
5344 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
5345 @xref{sort invocation}.
5348 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
5351 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
5354 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5359 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
5361 @opindex --skip-fields
5362 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
5363 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields.
5364 Fields are a sequence of blank characters followed by non-blank characters.
5365 Field numbers are one based, i.e., @option{-f 1} will skip the first
5366 field (which may optionally have leading blanks).
5368 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
5369 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
5372 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
5374 @opindex --skip-chars
5375 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
5376 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
5377 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
5379 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
5380 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
5381 @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
5383 Although this traditional behavior can be controlled with the
5384 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
5385 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
5386 behavior depends on this variable.
5387 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
5388 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
5394 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
5397 @itemx --ignore-case
5399 @opindex --ignore-case
5400 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
5406 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
5407 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
5408 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
5412 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
5414 @opindex --all-repeated
5415 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
5416 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
5417 but discard lines that are not repeated.
5418 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
5419 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
5420 The optional @var{delimit-method}, supported with the long form option,
5421 specifies how to delimit groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the
5427 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
5428 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
5431 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
5432 @macro nulOutputNote
5433 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
5434 byte (ASCII NUL) instead of a newline as the delimiter.
5439 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
5440 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
5441 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
5442 may be better suited for output direct to users.
5446 @macro ambiguousGroupNote
5447 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
5448 blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
5449 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\\n'} to
5454 This is a GNU extension.
5455 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
5457 @item --group[=@var{delimit-method}]
5459 @cindex all lines, grouping
5460 Output all lines, and delimit each unique group.
5462 The optional @var{delimit-method} specifies how to delimit
5463 groups, and must be one of the following:
5468 Separate unique groups with a single delimiter.
5469 This is the default delimiting method if none is specified,
5470 and better suited for output direct to users.
5473 Output a delimiter before each group of unique items.
5476 Output a delimiter after each group of unique items.
5479 Output a delimiter around each group of unique items.
5484 This is a GNU extension.
5490 @cindex unique lines, outputting
5491 Discard the last line that would be output for a repeated input group.
5492 When used by itself, this option causes @command{uniq} to print unique
5493 lines, and nothing else.
5496 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
5498 @opindex --check-chars
5499 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
5500 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
5504 @newlineFieldSeparator
5511 @node comm invocation
5512 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
5515 @cindex line-by-line comparison
5516 @cindex comparing sorted files
5518 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
5519 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
5520 standard input. Synopsis:
5523 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5527 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
5528 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
5529 If an input file ends in a non-newline
5530 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
5531 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
5533 @cindex differing lines
5534 @cindex common lines
5535 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
5536 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
5537 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
5538 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
5539 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
5540 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
5545 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
5546 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
5548 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
5549 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
5550 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
5551 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
5553 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
5554 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5555 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5556 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
5557 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5558 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
5560 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
5562 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
5565 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
5566 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5568 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
5569 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5570 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5571 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5573 @checkOrderOption{comm}
5578 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5580 @item --nocheck-order
5581 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
5585 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
5586 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
5587 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
5589 The delimiter @var{str} may be empty, in which case
5590 the ASCII NUL character is used to delimit output columns.
5593 Output a summary at the end.
5595 Similar to the regular output,
5596 column one contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file1},
5597 column two contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file2}, and
5598 column three contains the total number of lines common to both files,
5599 followed by the word @samp{total} in the additional column four.
5601 In the following example, @command{comm} omits the regular output
5602 (@option{-123}), thus just printing the summary:
5605 $ printf '%s\n' a b c d e > file1
5606 $ printf '%s\n' b c d e f g > file2
5607 $ comm --total -123 file1 file2
5611 This option is a GNU extension. Portable scripts should use @command{wc} to
5612 get the totals, e.g. for the above example files:
5615 $ comm -23 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file1
5617 $ comm -13 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file2
5619 $ comm -12 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines common to both files
5627 @node ptx invocation
5628 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
5632 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
5633 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
5636 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
5637 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5640 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
5641 all GNU extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
5642 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
5643 When @option{-G} is not specified, GNU extensions are always enabled.
5644 GNU extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
5645 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
5647 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
5649 When GNU extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
5650 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
5651 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
5652 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
5653 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
5654 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
5655 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
5656 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
5659 When GNU extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
5660 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
5661 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
5662 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
5663 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
5664 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
5665 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
5666 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
5667 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
5668 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
5669 compatibility; GNU Standards normally discourage output parameters not
5670 introduced by an option.
5672 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
5673 input text file, a single dash @samp{-} may be used, in which case
5674 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
5675 convention more than once per program invocation.
5678 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
5679 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
5680 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
5681 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
5682 * Compatibility in ptx::
5686 @node General options in ptx
5687 @subsection General options
5692 @itemx --traditional
5693 As already explained, this option disables all GNU extensions to
5694 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
5697 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
5701 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
5709 @node Charset selection in ptx
5710 @subsection Charset selection
5712 As it is set up now, @command{ptx} assumes that the input file is coded
5713 using 8-bit characters, and it may not work well in multibyte locales.
5714 In a single-byte locale, the default regular expression
5715 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
5716 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
5719 The output of @command{ptx} assumes the locale's character encoding.
5720 For example, with @command{ptx}'s @option{-T} option, if the locale
5721 uses the Latin-1 encoding you may need a LaTeX directive like
5722 @samp{\usepackage[latin1]@{inputenc@}} to render non-ASCII characters
5728 @itemx --ignore-case
5730 @opindex --ignore-case
5731 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5736 @node Input processing in ptx
5737 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5742 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5744 @opindex --break-file
5746 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5747 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5748 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5749 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5750 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5751 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5752 @option{-b} is ignored.
5754 When GNU extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5755 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5756 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When GNU extensions
5757 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5758 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5761 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5763 @opindex --ignore-file
5765 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5766 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5767 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5768 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5772 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5774 @opindex --only-file
5776 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5777 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5778 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5779 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5780 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5782 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5783 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5784 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5789 @opindex --references
5791 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5792 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5793 line in the resulting permuted index.
5794 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5795 for more information about reference production.
5796 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5798 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5799 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5800 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5801 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when GNU extensions
5802 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5803 excluded from the output contexts.
5805 @item -S @var{regexp}
5806 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5808 @opindex --sentence-regexp
5810 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5811 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5812 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5813 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5814 default, when GNU extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5815 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5816 imported from GNU Emacs:
5819 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5822 Whenever GNU extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5823 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5829 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5830 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5831 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5832 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5833 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5836 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5837 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5838 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5839 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5840 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5841 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5842 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5843 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5844 on the right of the output line.
5846 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5847 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5848 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5850 @item -W @var{regexp}
5851 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5853 @opindex --word-regexp
5855 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5856 By default, if GNU extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5857 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When GNU extensions are
5858 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5859 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5861 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5862 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5865 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5866 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5867 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5872 @node Output formatting in ptx
5873 @subsection Output formatting
5875 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5876 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5877 selected, and if GNU extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5878 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5879 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5880 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5881 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5882 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5883 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5884 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with GNU
5885 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5886 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5887 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5888 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5889 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5890 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5892 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5896 @item -g @var{number}
5897 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5901 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5904 @item -w @var{number}
5905 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5909 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5910 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5911 depending on the value of option @option{-R}@. If this option is not
5912 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5913 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5914 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5915 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5916 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5920 @itemx --auto-reference
5922 @opindex --auto-reference
5924 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5925 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5926 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5927 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5928 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5929 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5932 @itemx --right-side-refs
5934 @opindex --right-side-refs
5936 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5937 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5938 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5939 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5940 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5941 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5942 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5943 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5945 This option is automatically selected whenever GNU extensions are
5948 @item -F @var{string}
5949 @itemx --flag-truncation=@var{string}
5951 @opindex --flag-truncation
5953 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5954 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5955 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5956 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}@. But there is a maximum
5957 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5958 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5959 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5960 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5961 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5963 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F @dots{}}.
5964 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5965 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5968 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5969 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5970 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5972 @item -M @var{string}
5973 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5975 @opindex --macro-name
5977 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5978 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5981 @itemx --format=roff
5983 @opindex --format=roff
5985 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5986 processing. Each output line will look like:
5989 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5990 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5993 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5994 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when GNU
5995 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5996 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5998 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5999 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
6000 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character @samp{"} is doubled
6001 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
6006 @opindex --format=tex
6008 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
6009 line will look like:
6012 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
6013 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
6017 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
6018 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
6019 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
6020 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
6021 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
6024 In this output format, some special characters, like @samp{$}, @samp{%},
6025 @samp{&}, @samp{#} and @samp{_} are automatically protected with a
6026 backslash. Curly brackets @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} are protected with a
6027 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
6028 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
6029 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
6030 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
6031 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
6032 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
6033 and all other characters which are not part of ASCII, are merely
6034 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
6035 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
6036 processing for @TeX{}.
6041 @node Compatibility in ptx
6042 @subsection The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
6044 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
6045 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
6046 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
6047 options. Some GNU extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
6048 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about GNU extensions.
6049 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
6054 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
6055 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
6056 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
6057 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
6060 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
6061 practice which GNU avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
6062 portably between GNU and System V, you should always use it with a
6063 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
6064 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
6065 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
6066 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
6069 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
6070 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
6071 @option{-w}. All other options are GNU extensions and are not repeated in
6072 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
6073 meaning when GNU extensions are enabled, as explained below.
6076 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
6077 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
6078 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
6081 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
6082 subtracted from the total output line width. With GNU extensions
6083 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
6084 line width computations.
6087 All 256 bytes, even ASCII NUL bytes, are always read and
6088 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if GNU extensions
6089 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit
6090 characters, a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde
6091 @samp{~} is also rejected.
6094 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if GNU
6095 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
6096 the first 200 characters in each line.
6099 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
6100 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When GNU
6101 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
6105 The program makes better use of output line width. If GNU extensions
6106 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
6107 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
6108 not completely reproduce.
6111 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
6112 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
6117 @node tsort invocation
6118 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
6121 @cindex topological sort
6123 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
6124 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
6125 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
6129 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
6132 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
6133 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
6134 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
6148 will produce the output
6159 Consider a more realistic example.
6160 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
6161 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
6162 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
6163 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
6164 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
6165 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
6166 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
6167 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
6168 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
6169 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
6170 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
6171 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
6177 tail_file pretty_name
6178 tail_file write_header
6180 tail_forever recheck
6181 tail_forever pretty_name
6182 tail_forever write_header
6183 tail_forever dump_remainder
6186 tail_lines start_lines
6187 tail_lines dump_remainder
6188 tail_lines file_lines
6189 tail_lines pipe_lines
6191 tail_bytes start_bytes
6192 tail_bytes dump_remainder
6193 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
6194 file_lines dump_remainder
6198 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
6199 functions that satisfies your requirement.
6202 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
6222 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
6223 encountered to standard error.
6225 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
6226 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
6227 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
6228 precedes @code{main}.
6230 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
6236 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
6239 @node tsort background
6240 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
6242 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
6243 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
6244 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
6245 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
6248 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
6249 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
6250 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
6251 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
6252 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
6253 reference to @code{read}.
6255 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
6256 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
6257 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
6258 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
6261 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
6262 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
6264 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
6265 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
6266 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
6267 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
6270 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
6271 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
6275 @node Operating on fields
6276 @chapter Operating on fields
6279 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
6280 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
6281 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
6285 @node cut invocation
6286 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
6289 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
6290 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
6294 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6297 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
6298 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
6299 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
6300 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
6301 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
6302 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
6303 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
6304 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
6305 is written exactly once.
6307 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
6312 @item -b @var{byte-list}
6313 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
6316 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
6317 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
6318 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
6319 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
6320 string between ranges of selected bytes.
6322 @item -c @var{character-list}
6323 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
6325 @opindex --characters
6326 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
6327 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
6328 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
6329 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
6330 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
6331 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
6334 @item -f @var{field-list}
6335 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
6338 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
6339 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
6340 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
6341 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
6343 Note @command{awk} supports more sophisticated field processing,
6344 like reordering fields, and handling fields aligned with blank characters.
6345 By default @command{awk} uses (and discards) runs of blank characters
6346 to separate fields, and ignores leading and trailing blanks.
6349 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
6350 awk '{print $(NF-1)}' # print the penultimate field
6351 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
6354 Note while @command{cut} accepts field specifications in
6355 arbitrary order, output is always in the order encountered in the file.
6357 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
6358 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
6359 characters as @command{awk} does above.
6362 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
6363 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
6367 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
6368 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
6370 @opindex --delimiter
6371 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
6372 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
6376 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
6379 @itemx --only-delimited
6381 @opindex --only-delimited
6382 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
6383 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
6385 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
6386 @opindex --output-delimiter
6387 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
6388 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
6389 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
6390 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
6391 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
6392 ranges of selected bytes.
6395 @opindex --complement
6396 This option is a GNU extension.
6397 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
6398 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
6399 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
6400 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
6401 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
6410 @node paste invocation
6411 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
6414 @cindex merging files
6416 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
6417 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
6418 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
6424 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6438 Take lines sequentially from each file:
6446 Duplicate lines from a file:
6448 $ paste num2 let3 num2
6454 Intermix lines from standard input:
6456 $ paste - let3 - < num2
6462 Join consecutive lines with a space:
6464 $ seq 4 | paste -d ' ' - -
6469 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6477 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
6478 file. Using the above example data:
6481 $ paste -s num2 let3
6486 @item -d @var{delim-list}
6487 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
6489 @opindex --delimiters
6490 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
6491 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
6492 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
6495 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
6508 @node join invocation
6509 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
6512 @cindex common field, joining on
6514 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
6515 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
6518 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
6521 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
6522 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
6523 sorted on the join fields.
6545 @command{join}'s default behavior (when no options are given):
6547 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
6548 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
6549 blanks on the line ignored;
6550 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
6551 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
6552 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
6557 * General options in join:: Options which affect general program behavior.
6558 * Sorting files for join:: Using @command{sort} before @command{join}.
6559 * Working with fields:: Joining on different fields.
6560 * Paired and unpaired lines:: Controlling @command{join}'s field matching.
6561 * Header lines:: Working with header lines in files.
6562 * Set operations:: Union, Intersection and Difference of files.
6565 @node General options in join
6566 @subsection General options
6567 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6571 @item -a @var{file-number}
6573 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
6574 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
6577 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
6579 @item --nocheck-order
6580 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
6582 @item -e @var{string}
6584 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
6585 I.e., missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
6589 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines
6590 will be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
6591 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
6592 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
6593 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
6594 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
6597 @itemx --ignore-case
6599 @opindex --ignore-case
6600 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
6601 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
6602 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
6604 @item -1 @var{field}
6606 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
6608 @item -2 @var{field}
6610 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
6612 @item -j @var{field}
6613 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
6615 @item -o @var{field-list}
6617 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
6618 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
6619 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
6620 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
6623 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
6624 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
6625 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
6626 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
6628 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
6629 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
6630 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
6631 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
6632 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
6633 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
6634 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
6635 To give @command{join} that functionality, POSIX invented the @samp{0}
6636 field specification notation.
6638 The elements in @var{field-list}
6639 are separated by commas or blanks.
6640 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
6641 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
6642 2.2'} are equivalent.
6644 All output lines -- including those printed because of any @option{-a}
6645 or @option{-v} option -- are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
6648 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
6649 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
6650 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
6651 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
6652 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
6653 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the ASCII NUL
6654 character is used to delimit the fields.
6656 @item -v @var{file-number}
6657 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
6658 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
6661 @newlineFieldSeparator
6668 @checkOrderOption{join}
6673 @node Sorting files for join
6674 @subsection Pre-sorting
6676 @command{join} requires sorted input files. Each input file should be
6677 sorted according to the key (=field/column number) used in
6678 @command{join}. The recommended sorting option is @samp{sort -k 1b,1}
6679 (assuming the desired key is in the first column).
6681 @noindent Typical usage:
6684 $ sort -k 1b,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6685 $ sort -k 1b,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6686 $ join file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6691 Normally, the sort order is that of the
6692 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
6693 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
6694 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
6695 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
6696 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}:
6700 $ sort -k 1bf,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6701 $ sort -k 1bf,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6702 $ join --ignore-case file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6706 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
6707 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
6708 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
6709 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
6710 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
6711 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
6713 @noindent To avoid any locale-related issues, it is recommended to use the
6714 @samp{C} locale for both commands:
6718 $ LC_ALL=C sort -k 1b,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6719 $ LC_ALL=C sort -k 1b,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6720 $ LC_ALL=C join file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6725 @node Working with fields
6726 @subsection Working with fields
6728 Use @option{-1},@option{-2} to set the key fields for each of the input files.
6729 Ensure the preceding @command{sort} commands operated on the same fields.
6732 The following example joins two files, using the values from seventh field
6733 of the first file and the third field of the second file:
6737 $ sort -k 7b,7 file1 > file1.sorted
6738 $ sort -k 3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6739 $ join -1 7 -2 3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6744 If the field number is the same for both files, use @option{-j}:
6748 $ sort -k4b,4 file1 > file1.sorted
6749 $ sort -k4b,4 file2 > file2.sorted
6750 $ join -j4 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6755 Both @command{sort} and @command{join} operate of whitespace-delimited
6756 fields. To specify a different delimiter, use @option{-t} in @emph{both}:
6760 $ sort -t, -k3b,3 file1 > file1.sorted
6761 $ sort -t, -k3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6762 $ join -t, -j3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6767 To specify a tab (@sc{ascii} 0x09) character instead of whitespace,
6768 use:@footnote{the @code{$'\t'} is supported in most modern shells.
6769 For older shells, use a literal tab.}
6773 $ sort -t$'\t' -k3b,3 file1 > file1.sorted
6774 $ sort -t$'\t' -k3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6775 $ join -t$'\t' -j3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6781 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
6782 matches the default operation of sort:
6786 $ sort file1 > file1.sorted
6787 $ sort file2 > file2.sorted
6788 $ join -t '' file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6793 @node Paired and unpaired lines
6794 @subsection Controlling @command{join}'s field matching
6796 In this section the @command{sort} commands are omitted for brevity.
6797 Sorting the files before joining is still required.
6799 @command{join}'s default behavior is to print only lines common to
6800 both input files. Use @option{-a} and @option{-v} to print unpairable lines
6801 from one or both files.
6804 All examples below use the following two (pre-sorted) input files:
6806 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
6823 @c TODO: Find better column widths that work for both HTML and PDF
6824 @c and disable indentation of @example.
6825 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
6827 @headitem Command @tab Outcome
6837 (@emph{intersection})
6843 $ join -a 1 file1 file2
6848 common lines @emph{and} unpaired
6849 lines from the first file
6854 $ join -a 2 file1 file2
6859 common lines @emph{and} unpaired lines from the second file
6864 $ join -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6870 all lines (paired and unpaired) from both files
6873 see note below regarding @code{-o auto}.
6878 $ join -v 1 file1 file2
6882 unpaired lines from the first file
6888 $ join -v 2 file1 file2
6892 unpaired lines from the second file
6898 $ join -v 1 -v 2 file1 file2
6903 unpaired lines from both files, omitting common lines
6904 (@emph{symmetric difference}).
6910 The @option{-o auto -e X} options are useful when dealing with unpaired lines.
6911 The following example prints all lines (common and unpaired) from both files.
6912 Without @option{-o auto} it is not easy to discern which fields originate from
6916 $ join -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6921 $ join -o auto -e X -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6928 If the input has no unpairable lines, a GNU extension is
6929 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
6930 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
6931 considers them to be equal. For example:
6954 @subsection Header lines
6956 The @option{--header} option can be used when the files to join
6957 have a header line which is not sorted:
6971 $ join --header -o auto -e NA -a1 -a2 file1 file2
6980 To sort a file with a header line, use GNU @command{sed -u}.
6981 The following example sort the files but keeps the first line of each
6986 $ ( sed -u 1q ; sort -k2b,2 ) < file1 > file1.sorted
6987 $ ( sed -u 1q ; sort -k2b,2 ) < file2 > file2.sorted
6988 $ join --header -o auto -e NA -a1 -a2 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6992 @node Set operations
6993 @subsection Union, Intersection and Difference of files
6995 Combine @command{sort}, @command{uniq} and @command{join} to
6996 perform the equivalent of set operations on files:
6998 @c From https://www.pixelbeat.org/cmdline.html#sets
6999 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
7000 @headitem Command @tab outcome
7001 @item @code{sort -u file1 file2}
7002 @tab Union of unsorted files
7004 @item @code{sort file1 file2 | uniq -d}
7005 @tab Intersection of unsorted files
7007 @item @code{sort file1 file1 file2 | uniq -u}
7008 @tab Difference of unsorted files
7010 @item @code{sort file1 file2 | uniq -u}
7011 @tab Symmetric Difference of unsorted files
7013 @item @code{join -t '' -a1 -a2 file1 file2}
7014 @tab Union of sorted files
7016 @item @code{join -t '' file1 file2}
7017 @tab Intersection of sorted files
7019 @item @code{join -t '' -v2 file1 file2}
7020 @tab Difference of sorted files
7022 @item @code{join -t '' -v1 -v2 file1 file2}
7023 @tab Symmetric Difference of sorted files
7027 All examples above operate on entire lines and not on specific fields:
7028 @command{sort} without @option{-k} and @command{join -t ''} both consider
7029 entire lines as the key.
7032 @node Operating on characters
7033 @chapter Operating on characters
7035 @cindex operating on characters
7037 These commands operate on individual characters.
7040 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
7041 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
7042 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
7047 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
7054 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{string1} [@var{string2}]
7057 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
7058 one of the following operations:
7062 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
7064 squeeze repeated characters,
7068 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
7071 The @var{string1} and @var{string2} operands define arrays of
7072 characters @var{array1} and @var{array2}. By default @var{array1}
7073 lists input characters that @command{tr} operates on, and @var{array2}
7074 lists corresponding translations. In some cases the second operand is
7077 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7078 Options must precede operands.
7087 @opindex --complement
7088 Instead of @var{array1}, use its complement (all characters not
7089 specified by @var{string1}), in ascending order. Use this option with
7090 caution in multibyte locales where its meaning is not always clear
7091 or portable; see @ref{Character arrays}.
7097 Delete characters in @var{array1}; do not translate.
7100 @itemx --squeeze-repeats
7102 @opindex --squeeze-repeats
7103 Replace each sequence of a repeated character that is listed in
7104 the last specified @var{array}, with a single occurrence of that character.
7107 @itemx --truncate-set1
7109 @opindex --truncate-set1
7110 Truncate @var{array1} to the length of @var{array2}.
7118 * Character arrays:: Specifying arrays of characters.
7119 * Translating:: Changing characters to other characters.
7120 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters.
7124 @node Character arrays
7125 @subsection Specifying arrays of characters
7127 @cindex arrays of characters in @command{tr}
7129 The @var{string1} and @var{string2} operands are not regular
7130 expressions, even though they may look similar. Instead, they
7131 merely represent arrays of characters. As a GNU extension to POSIX,
7132 an empty string operand represents an empty array of characters.
7134 The interpretation of @var{string1} and @var{string2} depends on locale.
7135 GNU @command{tr} fully supports only safe single-byte locales,
7136 where each possible input byte represents a single character.
7137 Unfortunately, this means GNU @command{tr} will not handle commands
7138 like @samp{tr @"o @L{}} the way you might expect,
7139 since (assuming a UTF-8 encoding) this is equivalent to
7140 @samp{tr '\303\266' '\305\201'} and GNU @command{tr} will
7141 simply transliterate all @samp{\303} bytes to @samp{\305} bytes, etc.
7142 POSIX does not clearly specify the behavior of @command{tr} in locales
7143 where characters are represented by byte sequences instead of by
7144 individual bytes, or where data might contain invalid bytes that are
7145 encoding errors. To avoid problems in this area, you can run
7146 @command{tr} in a safe single-byte locale by using a shell command
7147 like @samp{LC_ALL=C tr} instead of plain @command{tr}.
7149 Although most characters simply represent themselves in @var{string1}
7150 and @var{string2}, the strings can contain shorthands listed below,
7151 for convenience. Some shorthands can be used only in @var{string1} or
7152 @var{string2}, as noted below.
7156 @item Backslash escapes
7157 @cindex backslash escapes
7159 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
7163 Bell (BEL, Control-G).
7165 Backspace (BS, Control-H).
7167 Form feed (FF, Control-L).
7169 Newline (LF, Control-J).
7171 Carriage return (CR, Control-M).
7173 Tab (HT, Control-I).
7175 Vertical tab (VT, Control-K).
7177 The eight-bit byte with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is the longest
7178 sequence of one to three octal digits following the backslash.
7179 For portability, @var{ooo} should represent a value that fits in eight bits.
7180 As a GNU extension to POSIX, if the value would not fit, then only the
7181 first two digits of @var{ooo} are used, e.g., @samp{\400}
7182 is equivalent to @samp{\0400} and represents a two-byte sequence.
7187 It is an error if no character follows an unescaped backslash.
7188 As a GNU extension, a backslash followed by a character not listed
7189 above is interpreted as that character, removing any special
7190 significance; this can be used to escape the characters
7191 @samp{[} and @samp{-} when they would otherwise be special.
7196 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to the characters
7197 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
7198 not collate after @var{n}; if it does, an error results. As an example,
7199 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
7201 GNU @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
7202 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
7203 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
7204 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
7205 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
7208 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not fully
7209 portable. For example, on EBCDIC hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
7210 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
7211 are not contiguous as they are in ASCII@.
7212 One way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
7213 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
7216 @item Repeated characters
7217 @cindex repeated characters
7219 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{string2} expands to @var{n}
7220 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
7221 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
7222 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{array2} as long as
7223 @var{array1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
7224 octal, otherwise in decimal. A zero-valued @var{n} is treated as if
7227 @item Character classes
7228 @cindex character classes
7230 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all characters in
7231 the (predefined) class @var{class}. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
7232 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
7233 character class can be used in @var{string2}. Otherwise, only the
7234 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
7235 @var{string2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
7236 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
7237 relative position in @var{string1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
7238 Except for case conversion, a class's characters appear in no particular order.
7239 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
7251 Horizontal whitespace.
7260 Printable characters, not including space.
7266 Printable characters, including space.
7269 Punctuation characters.
7272 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
7281 @item Equivalence classes
7282 @cindex equivalence classes
7284 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all characters equivalent to
7285 @var{c}, in no particular order. These equivalence classes are
7286 allowed in @var{string2} only when @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) and
7287 @option{--squeeze-repeats} @option{-s} are both given.
7289 Although equivalence classes are intended to support non-English alphabets,
7290 there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
7291 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in GNU @command{tr};
7292 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
7293 which is of no particular use.
7299 @subsection Translating
7301 @cindex translating characters
7303 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{string1} and @var{string2} are
7304 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
7305 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{array1}
7306 to the corresponding character in @var{array2}. Characters not in
7307 @var{array1} are passed through unchanged.
7309 As a GNU extension to POSIX, when a character appears more than once
7310 in @var{array1}, only the final instance is used. For example, these
7311 two commands are equivalent:
7318 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
7319 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
7322 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
7324 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
7328 However, ranges like @code{a-z} are not portable outside the C locale.
7330 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{array1} and @var{array2}
7331 typically have the same length. If @var{array1} is shorter than
7332 @var{array2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{array2} are ignored.
7334 On the other hand, making @var{array1} longer than @var{array2} is not
7335 portable; POSIX says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
7336 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{array2} to the length of @var{array1} by repeating
7337 the last character of @var{array2} as many times as necessary. System V
7338 @command{tr} truncates @var{array1} to the length of @var{array2}.
7340 By default, GNU @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
7341 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
7342 GNU @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
7343 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
7345 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
7349 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
7353 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
7354 complement of @var{array1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
7358 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
7359 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012. Here is a better
7363 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
7367 @node Squeezing and deleting
7368 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
7370 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
7371 @cindex deleting characters
7372 @cindex removing characters
7374 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
7375 removes any input characters that are in @var{array1}.
7377 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option
7378 and not translating, @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a
7379 repeated character that is in @var{array1} with a single occurrence of
7382 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
7383 first performs any deletions using @var{array1}, then squeezes repeats
7384 from any remaining characters using @var{array2}.
7386 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
7387 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
7388 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{array2}.
7390 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
7395 Remove all zero bytes:
7402 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
7403 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
7404 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
7407 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
7411 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline.
7412 I.e., delete empty lines:
7419 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
7420 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
7421 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
7422 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
7423 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
7424 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
7425 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
7426 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
7432 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
7433 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
7438 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
7439 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
7445 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
7446 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
7447 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
7448 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
7449 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
7450 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
7451 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
7452 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
7453 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
7460 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
7469 @node expand invocation
7470 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
7473 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
7474 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
7476 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
7477 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
7478 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
7482 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7485 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
7486 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
7487 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
7488 tabs every 8 columns).
7490 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7494 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7495 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7498 @cindex tab stops, setting
7499 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
7500 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
7501 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
7502 last tab stop given with single spaces.
7503 @macro gnuExpandTabs
7504 Tab stops can be separated by blanks as well as by commas.
7506 As a GNU extension the last @var{tab} specified can be prefixed
7507 with a @samp{/} to indicate a tab size to use for remaining positions.
7508 For example, @option{--tabs=2,4,/8} will set tab stops at position 2 and 4,
7509 and every multiple of 8 after that.
7511 Also the last @var{tab} specified can be prefixed with a @samp{+} to indicate
7512 a tab size to use for remaining positions, offset from the final explicitly
7514 For example, to ignore the 1 character gutter present in diff output,
7515 one can specify a 1 character offset using @option{--tabs=1,+8},
7516 which will set tab stops at positions 1,9,17,@dots{}
7521 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
7522 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
7523 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
7529 @cindex initial tabs, converting
7530 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
7531 characters) on each line to spaces.
7538 @node unexpand invocation
7539 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
7543 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
7544 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
7545 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
7546 as many tab characters as needed. In the default POSIX
7547 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
7548 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
7551 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7554 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
7555 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
7556 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
7557 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
7560 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7564 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7565 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7568 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
7569 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
7570 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
7571 beyond the tab stops given unchanged.
7574 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
7576 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
7577 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
7578 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
7579 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
7580 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
7586 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
7587 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
7594 @node Directory listing
7595 @chapter Directory listing
7597 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
7598 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
7601 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
7602 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
7603 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
7604 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
7609 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
7612 @cindex directory listing
7614 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
7615 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
7616 arbitrarily, as usual. Later options override earlier options that
7619 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
7620 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
7621 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
7622 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
7623 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
7624 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
7627 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
7628 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-POSIX
7629 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
7630 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
7631 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
7632 If standard output is
7633 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
7634 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
7635 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
7637 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
7638 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
7639 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
7640 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
7641 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
7643 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
7648 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
7649 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
7650 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
7651 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
7652 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
7653 or a directory loop)
7656 Also see @ref{Common options}.
7659 * Which files are listed::
7660 * What information is listed::
7661 * Sorting the output::
7662 * General output formatting::
7663 * Formatting file timestamps::
7664 * Formatting the file names::
7668 @node Which files are listed
7669 @subsection Which files are listed
7671 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
7672 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
7673 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
7674 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
7682 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
7687 @opindex --almost-all
7688 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
7689 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
7690 option overrides this option.
7693 @itemx --ignore-backups
7695 @opindex --ignore-backups
7696 @cindex backup files, ignoring
7697 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
7698 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
7703 @opindex --directory
7704 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
7705 than listing their contents.
7706 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
7707 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7708 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7709 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7710 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7713 @itemx --dereference-command-line
7715 @opindex --dereference-command-line
7716 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7717 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
7718 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
7720 @item --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
7721 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
7722 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7723 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
7724 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
7725 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
7727 This is the default behavior unless long format is being used
7728 or any of the following options is in effect:
7729 @option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
7730 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
7731 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7732 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
7734 @item --group-directories-first
7735 @opindex --group-directories-first
7736 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
7737 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
7738 (see @option{--sort} option).
7739 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
7740 and the @option{--sort} option specifies a secondary key.
7741 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
7742 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
7744 @item --hide=PATTERN
7745 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
7746 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
7747 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
7748 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
7749 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
7750 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
7751 (@option{-A}) is also given.
7753 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
7754 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
7755 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
7756 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
7758 @item -I @var{pattern}
7759 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
7761 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
7762 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
7763 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
7764 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
7765 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
7766 to give this option several times. For example,
7769 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
7772 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
7773 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
7774 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
7777 @itemx --dereference
7779 @opindex --dereference
7780 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7781 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
7782 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
7783 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
7784 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
7789 @opindex --recursive
7790 @cindex recursive directory listing
7791 @cindex directory listing, recursive
7792 List the contents of all directories recursively.
7797 @node What information is listed
7798 @subsection What information is listed
7800 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
7801 default, only file names are shown.
7807 @cindex hurd, author, printing
7808 In long format, list each file's author.
7809 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
7810 operating systems the two are the same.
7816 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
7817 Print an additional line after the main output:
7820 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
7824 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
7825 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
7826 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
7827 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
7829 If directories are being listed recursively via
7830 @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}), output a similar
7831 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
7834 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
7837 Finally, output a line of the form:
7840 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
7844 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
7846 Here is an actual example:
7849 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
7851 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
7852 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
7855 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
7856 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
7857 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
7858 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
7862 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
7866 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
7870 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
7871 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
7872 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
7875 The pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
7876 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
7878 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
7879 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
7881 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
7882 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
7885 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
7886 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
7890 Although the listing above includes a trailing slash
7891 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
7892 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
7893 (@option{-D}) along with an option like
7894 @option{--escape} (@option{-b}) and operate
7895 on a file whose name contains special characters, the backslash
7900 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
7901 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
7903 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
7906 If you use a quoting style like @option{--quoting-style=c} (@option{-Q})
7907 that adds quote marks, then the offsets include the quote marks.
7908 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
7909 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
7910 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal}
7911 (@option{-N}) option on the command line, or else be
7912 prepared to parse the escaped names.
7914 The @option{--dired} (@option{-D}) option implies long format output
7915 with hyperlinks disabled, and takes precedence over previously specified
7916 output formats or hyperlink mode.
7919 @opindex --full-time
7920 Produce long format, and list times in full. It is
7921 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} (@option{-l}) with
7922 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
7926 Produce long format, but omit owner information.
7932 Inhibit display of group information in long format.
7933 (This is the default in some non-GNU versions of @command{ls}, so we
7934 provide this option for compatibility.)
7942 @cindex inode number, printing
7943 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
7944 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
7945 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
7948 @itemx --format=long
7949 @itemx --format=verbose
7952 @opindex long ls @r{format}
7953 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
7954 Produce long format.
7955 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
7956 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
7957 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
7958 the modification timestamp (the mtime, @pxref{File timestamps}).
7959 If the owner or group name cannot be determined, print
7960 the owner or group ID instead, right-justified as a cue
7961 that it is a number rather than a textual name.
7962 Print question marks for other information that
7963 cannot be determined.
7965 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
7966 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7967 For example, @option{--human-readable} (@option{-h})
7968 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
7969 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
7970 separator of the current locale.
7972 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
7973 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the file system allocation
7974 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
7975 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7976 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
7977 this is arguably a deficiency.
7979 The file type is one of the following characters:
7981 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
7989 character special file
7991 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
7997 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
8001 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
8003 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
8005 network special file (HP-UX)
8011 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
8015 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
8017 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
8019 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
8021 some other file type
8024 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
8025 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
8026 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
8027 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
8031 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
8035 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
8036 executable bit is not set.
8039 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
8040 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
8041 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
8044 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
8045 other-executable bit is not set.
8048 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
8054 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
8055 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
8056 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
8057 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
8058 character, then there is such a method.
8060 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
8061 with a security context, but no other alternate access method.
8063 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
8064 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
8067 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
8069 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
8070 @cindex numeric uid and gid
8071 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
8072 Produce long format, but
8073 display right-justified numeric user and group IDs
8074 instead of left-justified owner and group names.
8078 Produce long format, but omit group information.
8079 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} (@option{-l})
8080 with @option{--no-group} (@option{-G}).
8086 @cindex file system allocation
8087 @cindex size of files, reporting
8088 Print the file system allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
8089 This is the amount of file system space used by the file, which is usually a
8090 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
8092 Normally the allocation is printed in units of
8093 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
8095 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
8096 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
8097 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
8098 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
8099 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
8100 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
8109 @cindex security context
8110 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
8111 In long format, print the security context to the left of the size column.
8116 @node Sorting the output
8117 @subsection Sorting the output
8119 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
8120 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
8121 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
8122 (e.g., ASCII order).
8128 @itemx --time=status
8131 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
8132 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
8133 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8135 print the status change timestamp (the ctime) instead of the mtime.
8136 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8137 sort according to the ctime. @xref{File timestamps}.
8141 @cindex unsorted directory listing
8142 @cindex directory order, listing by
8143 Produce an unsorted directory listing.
8144 This is like @option{--sort=none} (@option{-U}),
8145 but also enable @option{--all} (@option{-a}),
8146 while also disabling any previous use of @option{-l}, @option{--color}
8147 @option{--size}, or @option{--hyperlink}.
8153 @cindex reverse sorting
8154 Reverse whatever the sorting method is -- e.g., list files in reverse
8155 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
8156 This option has no effect when @option{--sort=none} (@option{-U})
8163 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
8164 Sort by file size, largest first.
8170 @opindex modification timestamp@r{, sorting files by}
8171 Sort by modification timestamp (mtime) by default, newest first.
8172 The timestamp to order by can be changed with the @option{--time} option.
8173 @xref{File timestamps}.
8177 @itemx --time=access
8181 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8182 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8183 @opindex access timestamp@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8184 In long format, print the last access timestamp (the atime).
8185 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8186 sort according to the atime.
8187 @xref{File timestamps}.
8190 @itemx --time=modification
8192 @opindex data modification time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8193 @opindex mtime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8194 This is the default timestamp display and sorting mode.
8195 In long format, print the last data modification timestamp (the mtime).
8196 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8197 sort according to the mtime.
8198 @xref{File timestamps}.
8201 @itemx --time=creation
8203 @opindex birth time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8204 @opindex creation timestamp@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8205 In long format, print the file creation timestamp if available,
8206 falling back to the file modification timestamp (mtime) if not.
8207 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8208 sort according to the birth time.
8209 @xref{File timestamps}.
8215 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8216 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
8217 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
8218 that @option{-f} does.) This can be useful when listing large
8219 directories, where sorting can take some time.
8222 @itemx --sort=version
8225 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8226 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
8227 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
8228 as an index/version number. @xref{Version sort ordering}.
8232 @opindex width@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8233 Sort by printed width of file names.
8234 This can be useful with the @option{--format=vertical} (@option{-C})
8235 output format, to most densely display the listed files.
8238 @itemx --sort=extension
8241 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
8242 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
8243 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
8248 @node General output formatting
8249 @subsection General output formatting
8251 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
8255 @item --format=single-column
8257 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
8258 List one file name per line, with no other information.
8259 This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
8260 output is not a terminal. See also the @option{--escape} (@option{-b}),
8261 @option{--hide-control-chars} (@option{-q}), and @option{--zero} options
8262 to disambiguate output of file names containing newline characters.
8266 List one file per line. This is like @option{--format=single-column}
8267 except that it has no effect if long format is also in effect.
8270 @itemx --format=vertical
8273 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
8274 List files in columns, sorted vertically, with no other information.
8275 This is the default for @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal.
8276 It is always the default for the @command{dir} program.
8277 GNU @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
8278 possible in the fewest lines.
8280 @item --color [=@var{when}]
8282 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
8283 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types; @var{when}
8284 may be omitted, or one of:
8287 @vindex none @r{color option}
8288 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
8290 @vindex auto @r{color option}
8291 @cindex terminal, using color iff
8292 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
8294 @vindex always @r{color option}
8297 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8298 @option{--color=always}.
8299 If piping a colored listing through a pager like @command{less},
8300 use the pager's @option{-R} option to pass the color codes to the terminal.
8303 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
8304 Using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
8305 performance penalty when run in a large directory,
8306 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
8307 single file it lists.
8308 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
8309 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
8310 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
8311 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
8313 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
8314 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
8316 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
8317 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
8320 @itemx --classify [=@var{when}]
8321 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
8324 @opindex --indicator-style
8325 @cindex file type and executables, marking
8326 @cindex executables and file type, marking
8327 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
8328 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
8329 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
8330 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
8331 and nothing for regular files.
8332 @var{when} may be omitted, or one of:
8335 @vindex none @r{classify option}
8336 - Do not classify. This is the default.
8338 @vindex auto @r{classify option}
8339 @cindex terminal, using classify iff
8340 - Only classify if standard output is a terminal.
8342 @vindex always @r{classify option}
8345 Specifying @option{--classify} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8346 @option{--classify=always}.
8347 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
8348 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
8349 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
8350 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
8351 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
8354 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
8355 @opindex --file-type
8356 @opindex --indicator-style
8357 @cindex file type, marking
8358 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
8359 like @option{--classify} (@option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
8361 @item --hyperlink [=@var{when}]
8362 @opindex --hyperlink
8363 @cindex hyperlink, linking to files
8364 Output codes recognized by some terminals to link
8365 to files using the @samp{file://} URI format.
8366 @var{when} may be omitted, or one of:
8369 @vindex none @r{hyperlink option}
8370 - Do not use hyperlinks at all. This is the default.
8372 @vindex auto @r{hyperlink option}
8373 @cindex terminal, using hyperlink iff
8374 - Only use hyperlinks if standard output is a terminal.
8376 @vindex always @r{hyperlink option}
8377 - Always use hyperlinks.
8379 Specifying @option{--hyperlink} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8380 @option{--hyperlink=always}.
8382 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
8383 @opindex --indicator-style
8384 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
8389 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
8391 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
8394 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
8395 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
8396 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
8398 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
8399 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{--classify}
8400 (@option{-F}) option.
8406 @opindex --kibibytes
8407 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
8408 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
8409 (@pxref{Block size}). If @option{--block-size},
8410 @option{--human-readable} (@option{-h}), or @option{--si} options are used,
8411 they take precedence even if @option{--kibibytes} (@option{-k}) is placed after
8413 The @option{--kibibytes} (@option{-k}) option affects the
8414 per-directory block count written in long format,
8415 and the file system allocation written by the @option{--size} (@option{-s})
8416 option. It does not affect the file size in bytes that is written in
8420 @itemx --format=commas
8423 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
8424 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
8425 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space),
8426 and with no other information.
8429 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
8431 @opindex --indicator-style
8432 @cindex file type, marking
8433 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
8436 @itemx --format=across
8437 @itemx --format=horizontal
8440 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
8441 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
8442 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
8445 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
8448 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
8449 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
8450 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
8452 Some terminal emulators might not properly align columns to the right of a
8453 TAB following a non-ASCII byte. You can avoid that issue by using the
8454 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment, to tell
8455 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
8457 If you set a terminal's hardware tabs to anything other than the default,
8458 you should also use a @command{--tabsize} option or @env{TABSIZE}
8459 environment variable either to match the hardware tabs, or to disable
8460 the use of hardware tabs. Otherwise, the output of @command{ls} may
8461 not line up. For example, if you run the shell command @samp{tabs -4}
8462 to set hardware tabs to every four columns, you should also run
8463 @samp{export TABSIZE=4} or @samp{export TABSIZE=0}, or use the
8464 corresponding @option{--tabsize} options.
8467 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
8471 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
8472 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
8473 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
8474 is 80. With a @var{cols} value of @samp{0}, there is no limit on
8475 the length of the output line, and that single output line will
8476 be delimited with spaces, not tabs.
8481 This option is incompatible with the @option{--dired} (@option{-D}) option.
8482 This option also implies the options @option{--show-control-chars},
8483 @option{-1}, @option{--color=none}, and
8484 @option{--quoting-style=literal} (@option{-N}).
8489 @node Formatting file timestamps
8490 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
8492 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
8493 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2020} for non-recent timestamps, and a
8494 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
8495 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
8498 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
8499 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
8500 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
8501 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
8502 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
8503 @xref{File timestamps}.
8506 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
8507 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
8508 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
8509 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8511 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
8514 @item --time-style=@var{style}
8515 @opindex --time-style
8517 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
8518 be one of the following:
8523 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
8524 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
8525 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
8526 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2020-03-30 23:45:56}. As
8527 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
8528 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
8530 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
8531 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
8532 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
8533 spaces in one of the two formats.
8536 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601-like date, time, and time zone
8537 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21
8538 23:45:56.477817180 -0400}. This style is equivalent to
8539 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
8541 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
8542 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
8543 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since GNU @command{make}
8544 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
8547 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
8548 @samp{2020-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
8549 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
8550 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
8553 List ISO 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
8554 @samp{2020-03-30@ }), and ISO 8601-like month, day, hour, and
8555 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
8556 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
8557 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
8558 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
8559 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
8564 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
8565 ls -l --time-style="iso"
8570 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a French
8571 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{30 mars@ @ @ 2020}
8572 and recent timestamps like @samp{30 mars@ @ 23:45}. Locale-dependent
8573 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
8574 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
8575 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
8577 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
8578 default POSIX locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
8579 @ 2020} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
8580 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
8585 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
8586 ls -l --time-style="locale"
8589 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
8590 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
8591 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
8592 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2020@ } and
8593 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
8595 @item posix-@var{style}
8597 List POSIX-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
8598 category is POSIX, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
8599 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
8600 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2020} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
8601 the POSIX locale, and like @samp{2020-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
8606 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
8607 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
8608 the default style is @samp{locale}. GNU Emacs 21.3 and
8609 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
8610 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
8611 non-POSIX locale you may need to set
8612 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
8614 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
8615 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
8618 @node Formatting the file names
8619 @subsection Formatting the file names
8621 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
8627 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
8630 @opindex --quoting-style
8631 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
8632 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
8633 backslash sequences like those used in C.
8637 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
8640 @opindex --quoting-style
8641 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
8642 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
8643 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
8647 @itemx --hide-control-chars
8649 @opindex --hide-control-chars
8650 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
8651 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
8656 @itemx --quoting-style=c
8658 @opindex --quote-name
8659 @opindex --quoting-style
8660 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
8663 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
8664 @opindex --quoting-style
8665 @cindex quoting style
8666 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
8667 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
8668 be one of the following:
8670 @macro quotingStyles
8673 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{--literal} (@option{-N})
8676 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
8677 cause ambiguous output.
8678 The quoting is suitable for POSIX-compatible shells like
8679 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
8682 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
8684 Like @samp{shell}, but also quoting non-printable characters using the POSIX
8685 proposed @samp{$''} syntax suitable for most shells.
8686 @item shell-escape-always
8687 Like @samp{shell-escape}, but quote strings even if they would
8688 normally not require quoting.
8690 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
8691 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
8692 @option{--quote-name} (@option{-Q}) option.
8694 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
8695 surrounding double-quote
8696 characters; this is the same as the @option{--escape} (@option{-b}) option.
8698 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
8699 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
8702 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
8703 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
8704 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
8705 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
8706 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
8711 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
8712 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment
8713 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{shell-escape} when the
8714 output is a terminal, and @samp{literal} otherwise.
8716 @item --show-control-chars
8717 @opindex --show-control-chars
8718 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
8719 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
8725 @node dir invocation
8726 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
8729 @cindex directory listing, brief
8731 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
8732 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
8733 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
8735 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
8738 @node vdir invocation
8739 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
8742 @cindex directory listing, verbose
8744 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
8745 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
8746 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
8748 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
8750 @node dircolors invocation
8751 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
8755 @cindex setup for color
8757 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
8758 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
8762 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
8765 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
8766 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
8767 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
8768 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
8770 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
8771 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
8772 adapt them to your favorite shell):
8776 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
8780 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
8781 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
8782 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
8783 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
8784 environment variable.
8786 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8791 @itemx --bourne-shell
8794 @opindex --bourne-shell
8795 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
8796 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
8797 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
8798 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
8807 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
8808 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
8809 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
8810 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
8813 @itemx --print-database
8815 @opindex --print-database
8816 @cindex color database, printing
8817 @cindex database for color setup, printing
8818 @cindex printing color database
8819 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
8820 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
8821 of the possibilities.
8823 @item --print-ls-colors
8824 @opindex --print-ls-colors
8825 @cindex printing ls colors
8826 Print the LS_COLORS entries on separate lines,
8827 each colored as per the color they represent.
8834 @node Basic operations
8835 @chapter Basic operations
8837 @cindex manipulating files
8839 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
8840 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
8843 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
8844 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
8845 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
8846 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
8847 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
8848 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
8853 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
8856 @cindex copying files and directories
8857 @cindex files, copying
8858 @cindex directories, copying
8860 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
8861 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
8862 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
8866 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8867 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8868 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8873 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
8877 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8878 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8879 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8880 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
8881 using the @var{source}s' names.
8884 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
8885 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
8887 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
8888 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
8889 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
8890 to corresponding destination directories.
8892 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
8893 link only when not copying recursively or when @option{--link}
8894 (@option{-l}) is used. This default can be overridden with the
8895 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
8896 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
8897 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
8898 the last one silently overrides the others.
8900 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
8901 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
8902 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
8903 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
8904 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
8905 practice and to POSIX@.
8906 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
8907 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
8908 Also, when an option like
8909 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
8910 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
8911 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
8913 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
8914 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
8915 @option{--copy-contents} option.
8917 @cindex self-backups
8918 @cindex backups, making only
8919 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
8920 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
8921 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
8922 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
8923 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
8924 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
8926 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8933 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
8934 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
8935 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
8936 directory in a different order).
8937 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
8938 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
8939 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
8941 @item --attributes-only
8942 @opindex --attributes-only
8943 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
8944 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
8945 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
8948 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
8951 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
8952 @cindex backups, making
8953 @xref{Backup options}.
8954 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
8955 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
8956 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
8957 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
8958 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
8962 # Usage: backup FILE...
8963 # Create a GNU-style backup of each listed FILE.
8966 cp --backup --force --preserve=all -- "$i" "$i" || fail=1
8971 @item --copy-contents
8972 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8973 @cindex copying directories recursively
8974 @cindex recursively copying directories
8975 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8976 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
8977 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
8978 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
8979 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
8980 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
8981 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
8982 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
8983 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
8984 fill up your destination file system if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
8985 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
8986 affect the copying of symbolic links.
8990 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8991 @cindex hard links, preserving
8992 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8993 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
8994 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
8999 @cindex debugging, copying
9000 Print extra information to stdout, explaining how files are copied.
9001 This option implies the @option{--verbose} option.
9009 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
9010 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force},
9011 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then
9012 tries to recreate the file by first removing it. Note @option{--force}
9013 alone will not remove dangling symlinks.
9014 When this option is combined with
9015 @option{--link} (@option{-l}) or @option{--symbolic-link}
9016 (@option{-s}), the destination link is replaced, and unless
9017 @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) is also given there is no brief
9018 moment when the destination does not exist. Also see the
9019 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
9021 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
9022 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
9024 This option is ignored when the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option
9029 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
9030 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
9031 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
9032 via recursive traversal.
9035 @itemx --interactive
9037 @opindex --interactive
9038 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
9039 overwrite an existing destination file, and fail if the response
9040 is not affirmative. The @option{-i} option overrides
9041 a previous @option{-n} option.
9047 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
9050 @itemx --dereference
9052 @opindex --dereference
9053 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
9054 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
9055 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
9056 a regular file in the destination tree.
9061 @opindex --no-clobber
9062 Do not overwrite an existing file; silently fail instead.
9063 This option overrides a previous
9064 @option{-i} option. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or
9065 @option{--backup} option.
9066 See also the @option{--update=none} option which will
9067 skip existing files but not fail.
9070 @itemx --no-dereference
9072 @opindex --no-dereference
9073 @cindex symbolic links, copying
9074 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
9075 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
9076 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
9079 @itemx --preserve[=@var{attribute_list}]
9082 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
9083 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
9084 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
9085 of one or more of the following strings:
9089 @cindex access control lists (ACLs)
9090 Preserve attributes relevant to access permissions,
9091 including file mode bits and (if possible) access control lists (ACLs).
9092 ACL preservation is system-dependent, and ACLs are not necessarily
9093 translated when the source and destination are on file systems with
9094 different ACL formats (e.g., NFSv4 versus POSIX formats).
9097 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
9098 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
9100 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
9101 a member of the desired group.
9103 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
9104 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
9105 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
9106 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
9107 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
9109 Preserve in the destination files
9110 any links between corresponding source files.
9111 Note that with @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
9112 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
9114 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
9119 Note the inputs: @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
9120 yet the files in destination directory, @file{c/}, are hard-linked.
9121 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--no-dereference} it would copy the symlink,
9122 but the later @option{-H} tells @command{cp} to dereference the command line
9123 arguments where it then sees two files with the same inode number.
9124 Then the @option{--preserve=links} option also implied by @option{-a}
9125 will preserve the perceived hard link.
9127 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
9129 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
9135 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
9137 @cindex access control lists (ACLs)
9138 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
9139 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
9140 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
9141 they are preserved implicitly by this option as well, i.e., even without
9142 specifying @option{--preserve=mode} or @option{--preserve=context}.
9144 Preserve all file attributes.
9145 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
9146 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
9147 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
9148 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
9151 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
9152 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
9154 In the absence of this option, the permissions of existing destination
9155 files are unchanged. Each new file is created with the mode of the
9156 corresponding source file minus the set-user-ID, set-group-ID, and
9157 sticky bits as the create mode; the operating system then applies either
9158 the umask or a default ACL, possibly resulting in a more restrictive
9160 @xref{File permissions}.
9162 @item --no-preserve=@var{attribute_list}
9163 @cindex file information, preserving
9164 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
9165 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
9169 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
9170 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
9171 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
9172 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
9173 For example, the command:
9176 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
9180 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
9181 any missing intermediate directories.
9188 @opindex --recursive
9189 @cindex directories, copying recursively
9190 @cindex copying directories recursively
9191 @cindex recursively copying directories
9192 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
9193 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
9194 links in the source unless used together with the @option{--link}
9195 (@option{-l}) option; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
9196 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
9197 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
9198 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
9199 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
9200 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
9201 non-GNU systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
9202 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
9203 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
9204 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as POSIX allows
9205 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
9207 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
9208 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
9211 @cindex copy on write
9212 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
9213 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
9214 files share the same data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
9215 Thus, if an I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
9216 the other suffers the same fate.
9218 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
9222 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported
9223 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
9224 Plain @option{--reflink} is equivalent to @option{--reflink=always}.
9227 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
9228 to the standard copy behavior.
9229 This is the default if no @option{--reflink} option is given.
9232 Disable copy-on-write operation and use the standard copy behavior.
9235 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
9236 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
9237 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
9239 @item --remove-destination
9240 @opindex --remove-destination
9241 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
9242 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
9244 @item --sparse=@var{when}
9245 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
9246 @cindex sparse files, copying
9247 @cindex holes, copying files with
9248 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
9249 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes} -- a sequence of zero bytes that
9250 does not occupy any file system blocks; the @samp{read} system call
9251 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable space and
9252 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
9253 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
9254 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
9255 Only regular files may be sparse.
9257 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
9261 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
9262 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
9263 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
9266 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
9267 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
9268 input file does not appear to be sparse.
9269 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
9270 that does not support sparse files
9271 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
9272 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
9273 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
9274 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
9277 Never make the output file sparse.
9278 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
9279 since such a file must not have any holes.
9282 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
9283 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
9284 (Older versions of @command{cp} can also benefit from
9285 @option{--reflink=auto} here.)
9288 alias cp='cp --sparse=always'
9291 @optStripTrailingSlashes
9294 @itemx --symbolic-link
9296 @opindex --symbolic-link
9297 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
9298 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
9299 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
9300 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
9301 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9307 @optNoTargetDirectory
9310 @itemx --update[=@var{which}]
9312 @opindex --update[=@var{which}]
9313 @cindex newer files, copying only
9314 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
9315 same or newer modification timestamp; instead, silently skip the file
9316 without failing. If timestamps are being preserved,
9317 the comparison is to the source timestamp truncated to the
9318 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
9319 used to update timestamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
9320 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
9321 This option is ignored if the @option{-n} or @option{--no-clobber}
9322 option is also specified.
9323 Also, if @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
9324 for example), that will take precedence; consequently, depending on the
9325 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
9326 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
9329 @var{which} gives more control over which existing files in the
9330 destination are replaced, and its value can be one of the following:
9334 This is the default operation when an @option{--update} option is not specified,
9335 and results in all existing files in the destination being replaced.
9338 This is similar to the @option{--no-clobber} option, in that no files in the
9339 destination are replaced, but also skipping a file does not induce a failure.
9342 This is the default operation when @option{--update} is specified, and results
9343 in files being replaced if they're older than the corresponding source file.
9352 Print the name of each file before copying it.
9355 @itemx --one-file-system
9357 @opindex --one-file-system
9358 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
9359 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
9360 the copy started on.
9361 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
9365 @itemx --context[=@var{context}]
9368 @cindex SELinux, setting/restoring security context
9369 @cindex security context
9370 Without a specified @var{context}, adjust the SELinux security context according
9371 to the system default type for destination files, similarly to the
9372 @command{restorecon} command.
9373 The long form of this option with a specific context specified,
9374 will set the context for newly created files only.
9375 With a specified context, if both SELinux and SMACK are disabled, a warning is
9379 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve=context}
9380 option, and overrides the @option{--preserve=all} and @option{-a} options.
9388 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
9391 @cindex converting while copying a file
9393 @command{dd} copies input to output with a changeable I/O block size,
9394 while optionally performing conversions on the data. Synopses:
9397 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
9401 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
9402 @xref{Common options}.
9404 By default, @command{dd} copies standard input to standard output.
9405 To copy, @command{dd} repeatedly does the following steps in order:
9409 Read an input block.
9412 If converting via @samp{sync}, pad as needed to meet the input block size.
9413 Pad with spaces if converting via @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, NUL
9417 If @samp{bs=} is given and no conversion mentioned in steps (4) or (5)
9418 is given, output the data as a single block and skip all remaining steps.
9421 If the @samp{swab} conversion is given, swap each pair of input bytes.
9422 If the input data length is odd, preserve the last input byte
9423 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
9426 If any of the conversions @samp{swab}, @samp{block}, @samp{unblock},
9427 @samp{lcase}, @samp{ucase}, @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic} and @samp{ibm}
9428 are given, do these conversions. These conversions operate
9429 independently of input blocking, and might deal with records that span
9433 Aggregate the resulting data into output blocks of the specified size,
9434 and output each output block in turn. Do not pad the last output block;
9435 it can be shorter than usual.
9438 @command{dd} accepts the following operands,
9439 whose syntax was inspired by the DD (data definition) statement of
9446 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
9450 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
9451 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, truncate @var{file} before writing it.
9453 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
9455 @cindex block size of input
9456 @cindex input block size
9457 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
9458 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
9459 The default is 512 bytes.
9461 @item obs=@var{bytes}
9463 @cindex block size of output
9464 @cindex output block size
9465 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
9466 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
9467 The default is 512 bytes.
9469 @item bs=@var{bytes}
9472 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
9473 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
9474 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
9475 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} operand is specified,
9476 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
9477 even if it is smaller than the block size.
9479 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
9481 @cindex block size of conversion
9482 @cindex conversion block size
9483 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
9484 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
9485 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
9486 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
9487 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
9488 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
9491 @itemx iseek=@var{n}
9494 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
9495 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B}, interpret @var{n}
9496 as a byte count rather than a block count.
9497 (@samp{B} and the @samp{iseek=} spelling are GNU extensions to POSIX.)
9500 @itemx oseek=@var{n}
9503 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before
9504 truncating or copying.
9505 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B}, interpret @var{n}
9506 as a byte count rather than a block count.
9507 (@samp{B} and the @samp{oseek=} spelling are GNU extensions to POSIX.)
9511 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
9512 of everything until the end of the file.
9513 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B},
9514 interpret @var{n} as a byte count rather than a block count;
9515 this is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9516 If short reads occur, as could be the case
9517 when reading from a pipe for example, @samp{iflag=fullblock}
9518 ensures that @samp{count=} counts complete input blocks
9519 rather than input read operations.
9520 As an extension to POSIX, @samp{count=0} copies zero blocks
9521 instead of copying all blocks.
9523 @item status=@var{level}
9525 Specify the amount of information printed.
9526 If this operand is given multiple times, the last one takes precedence.
9527 The @var{level} value can be one of the following:
9532 @opindex none @r{dd status=}
9533 Do not print any informational or warning messages to standard error.
9534 Error messages are output as normal.
9537 @opindex noxfer @r{dd status=}
9538 Do not print the final transfer rate and volume statistics
9539 that normally make up the last status line.
9542 @opindex progress @r{dd status=}
9543 Print the transfer rate and volume statistics on standard error,
9544 when processing each input block. Statistics are output
9545 on a single line at most once every second, but updates
9546 can be delayed when waiting on I/O.
9550 Transfer information is normally output to standard error upon
9551 receipt of the @samp{INFO} signal or when @command{dd} exits,
9552 and defaults to the following form in the C locale:
9556 116608+0 records out
9557 59703296 bytes (60 MB, 57 MiB) copied, 0.0427974 s, 1.4 GB/s
9560 The notation @samp{@var{w}+@var{p}} stands for @var{w} whole blocks
9561 and @var{p} partial blocks. A partial block occurs when a read or
9562 write operation succeeds but transfers less data than the block size.
9563 An additional line like @samp{1 truncated record} or @samp{10
9564 truncated records} is output after the @samp{records out} line if
9565 @samp{conv=block} processing truncated one or more input records.
9567 The @samp{status=} operand is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9569 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
9571 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
9572 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9579 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
9580 Convert EBCDIC to ASCII,
9581 using the conversion table specified by POSIX@.
9582 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
9583 This implies @samp{conv=unblock}; input is converted to
9584 ASCII before trailing spaces are deleted.
9587 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
9588 Convert ASCII to EBCDIC@.
9589 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
9590 This implies @samp{conv=block}; trailing spaces are added
9591 before being converted to EBCDIC@.
9594 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
9595 This acts like @samp{conv=ebcdic}, except it
9596 uses the alternate conversion table specified by POSIX@.
9597 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
9598 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
9600 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
9601 mutually exclusive. If you use any of these conversions, you should also
9602 use the @samp{cbs=} operand.
9605 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
9606 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
9607 input newline with a space and truncating or padding input lines with
9608 spaces as necessary.
9612 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
9613 and append a newline.
9615 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
9616 If you use either of these conversions, you should also use the
9617 @samp{cbs=} operand.
9620 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
9621 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
9624 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
9625 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
9627 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
9631 Try to seek rather than write NUL output blocks.
9632 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
9633 sparse output when extending the output file.
9634 Be careful when using this conversion in conjunction with
9635 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
9636 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output file
9637 corresponding to NUL blocks from the input, will be untouched.
9638 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
9639 Similarly, when the output is a device rather than a file,
9640 NUL input blocks are not copied, and therefore this conversion
9641 is most useful with virtual or pre zeroed devices.
9643 The @samp{sparse} conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9646 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
9647 @cindex byte-swapping
9648 Swap every pair of input bytes.
9651 @opindex sync @r{(padding with ASCII NULs)}
9652 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
9653 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
9658 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
9659 and don't affect internal processing:
9664 @cindex creating output file, requiring
9665 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
9670 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
9671 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
9673 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive,
9674 and are GNU extensions to POSIX.
9678 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
9679 Do not truncate the output file.
9683 @cindex read errors, ignoring
9684 Continue after read errors.
9688 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
9689 Synchronize output data just before finishing,
9690 even if there were write errors.
9691 This forces a physical write of output data,
9692 so that even if power is lost the output data will be preserved.
9693 If neither this nor @samp{fsync} are specified, output is treated as
9694 usual with file systems, i.e., output data and metadata may be cached
9695 in primary memory for some time before the operating system physically
9696 writes it, and thus output data and metadata may be lost if power is lost.
9697 @xref{sync invocation}.
9698 This conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9702 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
9703 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing,
9704 even if there were write errors.
9705 This acts like @samp{fdatasync} except it also preserves output metadata,
9706 such as the last-modified time of the output file; for this reason it
9707 may be a bit slower than @samp{fdatasync} although the performance
9708 difference is typically insignificant for @command{dd}.
9709 This conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9713 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
9715 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
9716 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9718 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
9720 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
9721 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9729 @cindex appending to the output file
9730 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
9731 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
9732 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
9733 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
9734 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
9735 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
9739 @cindex concurrent I/O
9740 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
9741 and drops the POSIX requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
9742 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
9748 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
9749 Note that the kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
9750 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a Linux-based kernel,
9751 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
9752 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
9756 @cindex directory I/O
9758 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
9759 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
9763 @cindex synchronized data reads
9764 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
9765 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
9766 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
9767 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
9768 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
9772 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
9773 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
9777 @cindex discarding file cache
9778 Request to discard the system data cache for a file.
9779 When count=0 all cached data for the file is specified,
9780 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
9781 portion of the file. Also when count=0,
9782 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
9783 and reflected in the exit status.
9785 Note data that is not already persisted to storage will not
9786 be discarded from cache, so note the use of the @samp{sync} conversions
9787 in the examples below, which are used to maximize the
9788 effectiveness of the @samp{nocache} flag.
9790 Here are some usage examples:
9793 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
9794 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
9796 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
9797 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
9799 # Advise to drop cache for part of file
9800 # Note the kernel will only consider complete and
9801 # already persisted pages.
9802 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
9804 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache.
9805 # See also the @samp{direct} flag.
9806 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache,sync
9811 @cindex nonblocking I/O
9812 Use non-blocking I/O.
9816 @cindex access timestamp
9817 Do not update the file's access timestamp.
9818 @xref{File timestamps}.
9819 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
9820 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
9824 @cindex controlling terminal
9825 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
9826 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
9827 On many hosts (e.g., GNU/Linux hosts), this flag has no effect
9832 @cindex symbolic links, following
9833 Do not follow symbolic links.
9838 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
9843 Use binary I/O@. This flag has an effect only on nonstandard
9844 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
9849 Use text I/O@. Like @samp{binary}, this flag has no effect on
9854 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
9855 may return early if a full block is not available.
9856 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
9858 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
9859 This flag is useful with pipes for example
9860 as they may return short reads. In that case,
9861 this flag is needed to ensure that a @samp{count=} argument is
9862 interpreted as a block count rather than a count of read operations.
9866 These flags are all GNU extensions to POSIX.
9867 They are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
9868 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
9869 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
9870 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
9871 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
9872 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
9876 The behavior of @command{dd} is unspecified if operands other than
9877 @samp{conv=}, @samp{iflag=}, @samp{oflag=}, and @samp{status=} are
9878 specified more than once.
9880 @cindex multipliers after numbers
9881 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{n} and @var{bytes})
9882 are unsigned decimal integers that
9883 can be followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
9884 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
9885 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
9886 These multipliers are GNU extensions to POSIX, except that
9887 POSIX allows @var{bytes} to be followed by @samp{k}, @samp{b}, and
9888 @samp{x@var{m}}. Note @samp{x@var{m}} can be used more than once in a number.
9889 Block sizes (i.e., specified by @var{bytes} strings) must be nonzero.
9891 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
9892 should not be too large -- values larger than a few megabytes
9893 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
9894 counterproductive or error-inducing.
9896 To process data with offset or size that is not a multiple of the I/O
9897 block size, you can use a numeric string @var{n} that ends in the
9899 For example, the following shell commands copy data
9900 in 1 MiB blocks between a flash drive and a tape, but do not save
9901 or restore a 512-byte area at the start of the flash drive:
9907 # Copy all but the initial 512 bytes from flash to tape.
9908 dd if=$flash iseek=512B bs=1MiB of=$tape
9910 # Copy from tape back to flash, leaving initial 512 bytes alone.
9911 dd if=$tape bs=1MiB of=$flash oseek=512B
9915 @cindex storage devices, failing
9916 For failing storage devices, other tools come with a great variety of extra
9917 functionality to ease the saving of as much data as possible before the
9918 device finally dies, e.g.
9919 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/ddrescue/, GNU @command{ddrescue}}.
9920 However, in some cases such a tool is not available or the administrator
9921 feels more comfortable with the handling of @command{dd}.
9922 As a simple rescue method, call @command{dd} as shown in the following
9923 example: the operand @samp{conv=noerror,sync} is used to continue
9924 after read errors and to pad out bad reads with NULs, while
9925 @samp{iflag=fullblock} caters for short reads (which traditionally never
9926 occur on flash or similar devices):
9929 # Rescue data from an (unmounted!) partition of a failing device.
9930 dd conv=noerror,sync iflag=fullblock </dev/sda1 > /mnt/rescue.img
9933 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal (or @samp{USR1} signal where that is unavailable)
9934 to a running @command{dd} process makes it print I/O statistics to
9935 standard error and then resume copying. In the example below,
9936 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 5GB of data.
9937 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
9938 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
9939 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
9942 # Ignore the signal so we never inadvertently terminate the dd child.
9943 # Note this is not needed when SIGINFO is available.
9946 # Run dd with the fullblock iflag to avoid short reads
9947 # which can be triggered by reception of signals.
9948 dd iflag=fullblock if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=5000000 bs=1000 & pid=$!
9950 # Output stats every second.
9951 while kill -s USR1 $pid 2>/dev/null; do sleep 1; done
9954 The above script will output in the following format:
9957 3441325+0 records in
9958 3441325+0 records out
9959 3441325000 bytes (3.4 GB, 3.2 GiB) copied, 1.00036 s, 3.4 GB/s
9960 5000000+0 records in
9961 5000000+0 records out
9962 5000000000 bytes (5.0 GB, 4.7 GiB) copied, 1.44433 s, 3.5 GB/s
9965 The @samp{status=progress} operand periodically updates the last line
9966 of the transfer statistics above.
9968 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
9969 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
9970 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
9971 environment variable is set.
9976 @node install invocation
9977 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
9980 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
9982 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
9983 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
9986 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
9987 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
9988 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
9989 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
9994 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
9998 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9999 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10000 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10001 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
10002 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
10005 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
10006 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
10007 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
10008 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
10009 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
10010 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
10013 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
10014 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
10015 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
10016 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
10017 files onto themselves.
10019 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
10020 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
10022 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10032 Compare content of source and destination files, and if there would be no
10033 change to the destination content, owner, group, permissions, and possibly
10034 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
10035 Note this option is best used in conjunction with @option{--user},
10036 @option{--group} and @option{--mode} options, lest @command{install}
10037 incorrectly determines the default attributes that installed files would have
10038 (as it doesn't consider setgid directories and POSIX default ACLs for example).
10039 This could result in redundant copies or attributes that are not reset to the
10044 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
10048 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
10049 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
10050 Explicitly specifying the @option{--target-directory=@var{dir}} will similarly
10051 ensure the presence of that hierarchy before copying @var{source} arguments.
10056 @opindex --directory
10057 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
10058 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
10059 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
10060 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
10061 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
10062 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
10066 @item -g @var{group}
10067 @itemx --group=@var{group}
10070 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
10071 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
10072 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
10073 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
10075 @item -m @var{mode}
10076 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10079 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
10080 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
10081 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
10082 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
10083 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
10084 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s} -- read, write, and
10085 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
10086 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
10087 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
10088 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
10089 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
10091 @item -o @var{owner}
10092 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
10095 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
10096 @cindex appropriate privileges
10097 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
10098 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
10099 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
10100 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
10103 @item --preserve-context
10104 @opindex --preserve-context
10106 @cindex security context
10107 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
10108 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
10109 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
10110 print a warning and ignore the option.
10113 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
10115 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
10116 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
10117 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
10118 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
10119 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
10120 last modification timestamps are both set to the time of installation.
10121 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification timestamps
10122 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
10123 to when they were last installed.
10129 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
10130 @cindex stripping symbol table information
10131 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
10133 @item --strip-program=@var{program}
10134 @opindex --strip-program
10135 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
10136 Program used to strip binaries.
10140 @optTargetDirectory
10141 Also specifying the @option{-D} option will ensure the directory is present.
10143 @optNoTargetDirectory
10149 Print the name of each file before copying it.
10152 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve-context} option.
10160 @node mv invocation
10161 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
10165 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
10168 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
10169 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
10170 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
10175 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
10179 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10180 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10181 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10182 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
10183 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
10186 To move a file, @command{mv} ordinarily simply renames it.
10187 However, if renaming does not work because the destination's file
10188 system differs, @command{mv} falls back on copying as if by @code{cp -a},
10189 then (assuming the copy succeeded) it removes the original.
10190 If the copy fails, then @command{mv} removes any partially created
10191 copy in the destination. If you were to copy three directories from
10192 one file system to another and the copy of the first
10193 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
10194 the destination file system and the second and third would be left on the
10195 original file system.
10197 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
10198 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
10199 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
10200 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
10202 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
10203 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
10204 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
10205 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
10206 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
10207 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
10209 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
10210 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
10211 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
10212 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
10213 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
10214 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}@.
10215 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
10216 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
10217 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
10219 @emph{Note}: @command{mv} will only replace empty directories in the
10220 destination. Conflicting populated directories are skipped with a diagnostic.
10222 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10234 @cindex prompts, omitting
10235 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
10237 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
10238 options, only the final one takes effect.
10243 @itemx --interactive
10245 @opindex --interactive
10246 @cindex prompts, forcing
10247 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
10248 of its permissions, and fail if the response is not affirmative.
10252 @itemx --no-clobber
10254 @opindex --no-clobber
10255 @cindex prompts, omitting
10256 Do not overwrite an existing file; silently fail instead.
10258 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
10259 See also the @option{--update=none} option which will
10260 skip existing files but not fail.
10264 @cindex renaming files without copying them
10265 If a file cannot be renamed because the destination file system differs,
10266 fail with a diagnostic instead of copying and then removing the file.
10272 @cindex newer files, moving only
10273 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
10274 same or newer modification timestamp;
10275 instead, silently skip the file without failing.
10276 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
10277 source timestamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
10278 system and of the system calls used to update timestamps; this avoids
10279 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
10280 same source and destination.
10281 This option is ignored if the @option{-n} or @option{--no-clobber}
10282 option is also specified.
10290 Print the name of each file before moving it.
10292 @optStripTrailingSlashes
10296 @optTargetDirectory
10298 @optNoTargetDirectory
10304 @cindex SELinux, restoring security context
10305 @cindex security context
10306 This option functions similarly to the @command{restorecon} command,
10307 by adjusting the SELinux security context according
10308 to the system default type for destination files and each created directory.
10315 @node rm invocation
10316 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
10319 @cindex removing files or directories
10321 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
10322 directories. Synopsis:
10325 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10328 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
10329 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
10330 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
10331 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
10332 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
10333 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
10335 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
10336 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
10337 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
10338 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
10339 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
10341 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
10342 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting, as mandated
10345 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
10346 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
10347 that the contents are unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
10349 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10357 @cindex directories, removing
10358 Remove the listed directories if they are empty.
10364 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
10365 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
10369 Prompt whether to remove each file.
10370 If the response is not affirmative, silently skip the file without failing.
10371 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
10372 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
10376 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
10377 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
10378 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
10379 @option{--interactive=once}.
10381 @item --interactive [=@var{when}]
10382 @opindex --interactive
10383 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
10384 omitted, or one of:
10387 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
10388 - Do not prompt at all.
10390 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
10391 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
10392 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
10394 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
10395 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
10397 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
10398 @option{--interactive=always}.
10400 @item --one-file-system
10401 @opindex --one-file-system
10402 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
10403 When removing a hierarchy recursively, do not remove any directory that is on a
10404 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
10406 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
10407 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
10408 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
10409 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
10410 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
10411 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
10412 under @file{/home}, too.
10413 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
10414 diagnose and skip directories on other file systems.
10415 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
10416 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
10417 See also @option{--preserve-root=all} to protect command line arguments
10420 @item --preserve-root [=all]
10421 @opindex --preserve-root
10422 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
10423 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
10424 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
10425 This is the default behavior.
10426 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10427 When @samp{all} is specified, reject any command line argument
10428 that is not on the same file system as its parent.
10430 @item --no-preserve-root
10431 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10432 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
10433 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
10434 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
10435 remove all the files on your computer.
10436 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10443 @opindex --recursive
10444 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
10445 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
10451 Print the name of each file before removing it.
10455 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
10456 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
10457 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
10458 @samp{-}. GNU @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
10459 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
10460 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
10461 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
10474 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
10475 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
10476 predates the development of the @code{getopt} standard syntax.
10481 @node shred invocation
10482 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
10485 @cindex data, erasing
10486 @cindex erasing data
10488 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
10489 extensive forensics from recovering the data.
10491 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), its data
10492 and metadata are not actually destroyed. Only the file's directory
10493 entry is removed, and the file's storage is reclaimed only when no
10494 process has the file open and no other directory entry links to the
10495 file. And even if file's data and metadata's storage space is freed
10496 for further reuse, there are undelete utilities that will attempt to
10497 reconstruct the file from the data in freed storage, and that can
10498 bring the file back if the storage was not rewritten.
10500 On a busy system with a nearly-full device, space can get reused in a few
10501 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. And although the
10502 undelete utilities and already-existing processes require insider or
10503 superuser access, you may be wary of the superuser,
10504 of processes running on your behalf, or of attackers
10505 that can physically access the storage device. So if you have sensitive
10506 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible
10507 by plausible attacks like these.
10509 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
10510 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
10511 this is often the preferred method. However, some storage devices
10512 are expensive or are harder to destroy, so the @command{shred} utility tries
10513 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively, by overwriting the file
10514 with non-sensitive data.
10516 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a crucial
10517 assumption: that the file system and hardware overwrite data in place.
10518 Although this is common and is the traditional
10519 way to do things, many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
10520 assumption. Exceptions include:
10525 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as ext3/ext4 (in
10526 @code{data=journal} mode), Btrfs, NTFS, ReiserFS, XFS, ZFS, file
10527 systems supplied with AIX and Solaris, etc., when they are configured to
10531 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
10532 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
10535 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
10538 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
10542 Compressed file systems.
10545 For ext3 and ext4 file systems, @command{shred} is less effective
10546 when the file system is in @code{data=journal}
10547 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
10548 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
10549 @command{shred} works as usual. The ext3/ext4 journaling modes can be changed
10550 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
10551 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
10552 the @command{mount} man page (@samp{man mount}). Alternatively, if
10553 you know how large the journal is, you can shred the journal by
10554 shredding enough file data so that the journal cycles around and fills
10555 up with shredded data.
10557 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
10558 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means @command{shred} cannot
10559 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
10561 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
10562 since this bypasses file system design issues mentioned above.
10563 However, devices are also problematic for shredding, for reasons
10564 such as the following:
10569 Solid-state storage devices (SSDs) typically do wear leveling to
10570 prolong service life, and this means writes are distributed to other
10571 blocks by the hardware, so ``overwritten'' data blocks are still
10572 present in the underlying device.
10575 Most storage devices map out bad blocks invisibly to
10576 the application; if the bad blocks contain sensitive data,
10577 @command{shred} won't be able to destroy it.
10580 With some obsolete storage technologies,
10581 it may be possible to take (say) a floppy disk back
10582 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
10583 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
10584 overwritten data. With these older technologies, if the file has been
10585 overwritten only once, it's reputedly not even that hard. Luckily,
10586 this kind of data recovery has become difficult, and there is no
10587 public evidence that today's higher-density storage devices can be
10588 analyzed in this way.
10590 The @command{shred} command can use many overwrite passes,
10591 with data patterns chosen to
10592 maximize the damage they do to the old data.
10593 By default the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives using
10594 now-obsolete technology; for newer devices, a single pass should suffice.
10595 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
10596 @uref{https://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
10597 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
10598 from the proceedings of the Sixth USENIX Security Symposium (San Jose,
10599 California, July 22--25, 1996).
10602 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report these problems, just as
10603 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
10604 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
10605 not deallocate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
10606 for devices, which typically cannot be deallocated and should not be
10609 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
10610 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
10611 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
10612 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
10613 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
10616 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
10619 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10627 @cindex force deletion
10628 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
10630 @item -n @var{number}
10631 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
10632 @opindex -n @var{number}
10633 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
10634 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
10635 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
10636 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
10637 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
10638 been used at least once.
10640 @item --random-source=@var{file}
10641 @opindex --random-source
10642 @cindex random source for shredding
10643 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
10644 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
10646 @item -s @var{bytes}
10647 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
10648 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
10649 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
10650 @cindex size of file to shred
10651 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
10652 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
10653 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
10656 @itemx --remove[=@var{how}]
10659 @opindex --remove=unlink
10660 @opindex --remove=wipe
10661 @opindex --remove=wipesync
10662 @cindex removing files after shredding
10663 After shredding a file, deallocate it (if possible) and then remove it.
10664 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
10665 Often the file name is less sensitive than the file data, in which case
10666 the optional @var{how} parameter, supported with the long form option,
10667 gives control of how to more efficiently remove each directory entry.
10668 The @samp{unlink} parameter will just use a standard unlink call,
10669 @samp{wipe} will also first obfuscate bytes in the name, and
10670 @samp{wipesync} will also sync each obfuscated byte in the name to
10672 Note @samp{wipesync} is the default method, but can be expensive,
10673 requiring a sync for every character in every file. This can become
10674 significant with many files, or is redundant if your file system provides
10675 synchronous metadata updates.
10681 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
10687 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
10688 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the slack space in
10689 the last block of the file. This space may contain portions of the current
10690 system memory on some systems for example.
10691 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
10692 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
10693 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
10694 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
10700 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
10701 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your storage device (for
10702 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
10703 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
10704 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
10705 by the @option{--iterations} option.
10709 You might use the following command to erase the file system you
10710 created on a USB flash drive. This command typically takes several
10711 minutes, depending on the drive's size and write speed. On modern
10712 storage devices a single pass should be adequate, and will take one
10713 third the time of the default three-pass approach.
10716 shred -v -n 1 /dev/sdd1
10719 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
10720 your device, you could give a command like the following.
10723 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
10724 shred -v -n1 /dev/sda5
10727 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
10728 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
10729 in case some device controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
10730 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
10731 Some SSDs may do just that.
10733 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
10734 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
10741 echo "Hello, world" >&3
10746 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
10747 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
10748 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
10749 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
10754 @node Special file types
10755 @chapter Special file types
10757 @cindex special file types
10758 @cindex file types, special
10760 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
10761 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
10763 @cindex special file types
10765 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
10766 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
10767 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
10768 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
10769 which it does in a @dfn{directory} -- a special type of file. Although
10770 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
10771 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
10772 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
10774 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
10775 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
10778 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
10779 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
10780 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
10781 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
10782 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
10783 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
10784 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
10785 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
10789 @node link invocation
10790 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
10793 @cindex links, creating
10794 @cindex hard links, creating
10795 @cindex creating links (hard only)
10797 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
10798 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
10799 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
10800 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10801 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
10802 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
10806 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
10809 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
10810 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
10811 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
10812 to create the link.
10814 On a GNU system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
10815 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
10816 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
10817 not specified by POSIX, and the @command{link} command is
10818 more portable in practice.
10820 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
10821 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
10822 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
10823 to specify which behavior is desired.
10828 @node ln invocation
10829 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
10832 @cindex links, creating
10833 @cindex hard links, creating
10834 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
10835 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
10837 @cindex file systems and hard links
10838 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
10839 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
10843 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
10844 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
10845 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
10846 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
10852 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
10853 file from the second.
10856 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
10857 in the current directory.
10860 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10861 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10862 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10863 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
10864 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
10868 Normally @command{ln} does not replace existing files. Use the
10869 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to replace them unconditionally,
10870 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to replace them
10871 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
10872 rename them. Unless the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option is
10873 used there is no brief moment when the destination does not exist;
10874 this is an extension to POSIX.
10876 @cindex hard link, defined
10877 @cindex inode, and hard links
10878 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
10879 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
10880 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
10881 file -- indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
10882 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
10883 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
10884 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
10885 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
10886 restrictions are not mandated by POSIX, however.)
10888 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
10889 @cindex symbolic link, defined
10890 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
10891 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
10892 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
10893 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
10894 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
10895 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
10896 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
10897 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
10898 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
10899 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
10900 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
10901 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
10902 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
10903 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
10904 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10906 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
10907 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
10908 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
10909 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
10910 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
10911 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
10912 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
10913 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
10914 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
10915 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
10916 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
10919 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
10920 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
10921 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
10922 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
10923 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
10924 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
10925 what will be placed in the symlink.
10927 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10938 @opindex --directory
10939 @cindex hard links to directories
10940 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
10942 However, note that this will probably fail due to
10943 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
10949 Remove existing destination files.
10952 @itemx --interactive
10954 @opindex --interactive
10955 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
10956 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files,
10957 and fail if the response is not affirmative.
10963 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
10964 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
10965 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
10968 @itemx --no-dereference
10970 @opindex --no-dereference
10971 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
10972 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
10974 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
10975 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
10976 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
10977 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
10978 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
10979 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
10980 non-directory -- as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
10981 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
10982 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
10983 just like a directory.
10985 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
10986 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
10991 @opindex --physical
10992 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
10993 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
10994 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
10995 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
10996 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
10997 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
11002 @opindex --relative
11003 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
11004 This option is only valid with the @option{--symbolic} option.
11009 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
11010 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
11013 Relative symbolic links are generated based on their canonicalized
11014 containing directory, and canonicalized targets. I.e., all symbolic
11015 links in these file names will be resolved.
11016 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
11017 over relative file name generation, as demonstrated in the following example:
11022 test "$1" = --no-symlinks && { nosym=$1; shift; }
11024 test -d "$2" && link="$2/." || link="$2"
11025 rtarget="$(realpath $nosym -m "$target" \
11026 --relative-to "$(dirname "$link")")"
11027 ln -s -v "$rtarget" "$link"
11035 @opindex --symbolic
11036 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
11037 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
11041 @optTargetDirectory
11043 @optNoTargetDirectory
11049 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
11053 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
11054 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
11055 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
11056 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
11057 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
11058 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
11059 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
11060 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
11069 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
11070 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
11075 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
11081 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
11082 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
11086 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
11087 # work across networked file systems.
11088 ln -s afile anotherfile
11089 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
11093 @node mkdir invocation
11094 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
11097 @cindex directories, creating
11098 @cindex creating directories
11100 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
11103 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11106 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
11107 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
11108 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
11110 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11114 @item -m @var{mode}
11115 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11118 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
11119 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
11120 which uses the same syntax as
11121 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
11122 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
11123 This option affects only directories given on the command line;
11124 it does not affect any parents that may be created via the @option{-p} option.
11126 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
11127 is created. As a GNU extension, @var{mode} may also mention
11128 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
11129 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
11130 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
11131 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
11132 overridden in this way.
11138 @cindex parent directories, creating
11139 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
11140 file permission bits to @samp{=rwx,u+wx},
11141 that is, with the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
11142 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
11145 If the @option{-m} option is also given, it does not affect
11146 file permission bits of any newly-created parent directories.
11147 To control these bits, set the
11148 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
11149 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
11150 @file{P} it sets the parent's file permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
11151 (The umask must include @samp{u=wx} for this method to work.)
11152 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
11153 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
11154 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
11155 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
11161 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
11162 @option{--parents}.
11171 @node mkfifo invocation
11172 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
11175 @cindex FIFOs, creating
11176 @cindex named pipes, creating
11177 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
11179 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
11180 specified names. Synopsis:
11183 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
11186 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
11187 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
11188 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
11189 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
11191 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11195 @item -m @var{mode}
11196 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11199 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
11200 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
11201 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
11202 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
11203 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
11212 @node mknod invocation
11213 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
11216 @cindex block special files, creating
11217 @cindex character special files, creating
11219 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
11220 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
11223 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
11226 @cindex special files
11227 @cindex block special files
11228 @cindex character special files
11229 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
11230 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
11231 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
11232 e.g., a printer or a flash drive. (These files are typically created at
11233 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
11234 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
11235 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
11236 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
11238 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
11239 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
11241 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
11246 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
11250 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
11251 for a block special file
11254 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
11255 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
11257 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
11258 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
11259 for a character special file
11263 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
11264 device numbers must be given after the file type.
11265 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
11266 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
11267 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
11269 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11273 @item -m @var{mode}
11274 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11277 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
11278 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
11279 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
11280 @xref{File permissions}.
11289 @node readlink invocation
11290 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
11293 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
11294 @cindex canonical file name
11295 @cindex canonicalize a file name
11298 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
11302 @item Readlink mode
11304 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic links.
11305 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
11306 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
11308 @item Canonicalize mode
11310 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given files which contain
11311 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
11312 (@file{/}) or symbolic links. Note the @command{realpath} command is the
11313 preferred command to use for canonicalization. @xref{realpath invocation}.
11318 readlink [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11321 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
11323 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11328 @itemx --canonicalize
11330 @opindex --canonicalize
11331 Activate canonicalize mode.
11332 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
11333 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
11334 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
11337 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
11339 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
11340 Activate canonicalize mode.
11341 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
11342 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
11343 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
11346 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
11348 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
11349 Activate canonicalize mode.
11350 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
11354 @itemx --no-newline
11356 @opindex --no-newline
11357 Do not print the output delimiter, when a single @var{file} is specified.
11358 Print a warning if specified along with multiple @var{file}s.
11368 Suppress most error messages. On by default.
11374 Report error messages.
11380 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
11382 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
11383 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
11388 @node rmdir invocation
11389 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
11392 @cindex removing empty directories
11393 @cindex directories, removing empty
11395 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
11398 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
11401 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
11402 directory, it is an error.
11404 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11408 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
11409 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
11410 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
11411 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is non-empty.
11417 @cindex parent directories, removing
11418 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
11419 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
11420 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
11421 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
11422 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
11423 exit unsuccessfully.
11429 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
11430 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
11431 @var{directory} is removed.
11435 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories recursively.
11437 To remove all empty directories under @var{dirname}, including
11438 directories that become empty because other directories are removed,
11439 you can use either of the following commands:
11442 # This uses GNU extensions.
11443 find @var{dirname} -type d -empty -delete
11445 # This runs on any POSIX platform.
11446 find @var{dirname} -depth -type d -exec rmdir @{@} +
11452 @node unlink invocation
11453 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
11456 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
11458 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
11459 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
11460 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
11461 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
11462 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
11463 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
11466 unlink @var{filename}
11469 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
11470 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
11471 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
11473 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
11474 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
11475 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
11480 @node Changing file attributes
11481 @chapter Changing file attributes
11483 @cindex changing file attributes
11484 @cindex file attributes, changing
11485 @cindex attributes, file
11487 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
11488 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
11489 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
11490 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
11491 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
11494 These commands change file attributes.
11497 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
11498 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
11499 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
11500 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
11504 @node chown invocation
11505 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
11508 @cindex file ownership, changing
11509 @cindex group ownership, changing
11510 @cindex changing file ownership
11511 @cindex changing group ownership
11513 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
11514 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
11518 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11522 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
11523 (with no embedded white space):
11526 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
11533 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
11534 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
11537 @item owner@samp{:}group
11538 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
11539 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
11540 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
11542 @item owner@samp{:}
11543 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
11544 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
11545 @var{owner}'s login group.
11547 @item @samp{:}group
11548 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
11549 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
11550 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
11553 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
11554 owner nor the group is changed.
11558 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
11559 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
11560 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
11562 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
11563 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
11564 require support for that, but for backward compatibility GNU
11565 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results,
11566 although it issues a warning and support may be removed in future versions.
11567 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
11568 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
11569 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
11572 @macro chownGroupRestrictions
11573 It is system dependent whether a user can change the group to an arbitrary one,
11574 or the more portable behavior of being restricted to setting a group of
11575 which the user is a member.
11577 @chownGroupRestrictions
11579 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
11580 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
11581 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
11582 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
11583 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
11584 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
11585 privileges, or when the
11586 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
11587 mandatory locking).
11588 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
11590 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11598 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
11599 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
11608 @cindex error messages, omitting
11609 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
11612 @macro chownFromOption{cmd}
11613 @item --from=@var{old-owner}
11615 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11616 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
11617 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
11619 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
11620 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
11621 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
11622 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
11625 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 \cmd\ -h NEWUSER
11628 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
11629 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{\cmd\} is actually run
11630 may be quite large.
11631 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke \cmd\ for each file
11635 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec \cmd\ -h NEWUSER @{@} \\;
11638 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
11639 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
11640 though still not perfect:
11643 \cmd\ -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
11646 @chownFromOption{chown}
11648 @item --dereference
11649 @opindex --dereference
11650 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11652 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
11653 This is the default when not operating recursively.
11654 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11657 @itemx --no-dereference
11659 @opindex --no-dereference
11660 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11662 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
11663 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
11664 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
11665 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
11666 is a symbolic link.
11667 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
11668 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
11670 @item --preserve-root
11671 @opindex --preserve-root
11672 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11673 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11674 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11675 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11677 @item --no-preserve-root
11678 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11679 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11680 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11681 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11683 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11684 @opindex --reference
11685 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
11686 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
11687 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
11694 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
11695 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
11696 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
11697 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
11698 its referent is being changed.
11703 @opindex --recursive
11704 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
11705 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
11708 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11711 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11712 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11715 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11724 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
11727 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
11728 chown root:staff /u
11730 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
11735 @node chgrp invocation
11736 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
11739 @cindex group ownership, changing
11740 @cindex changing group ownership
11742 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
11743 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
11744 or to the group of an existing reference file. @xref{chown invocation}.
11748 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11752 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
11753 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
11754 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
11756 @chownGroupRestrictions
11758 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11766 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
11767 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
11776 @cindex error messages, omitting
11777 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
11780 @chownFromOption{chgrp}
11782 @item --dereference
11783 @opindex --dereference
11784 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11786 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
11787 This is the default when not operating recursively.
11788 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11791 @itemx --no-dereference
11793 @opindex --no-dereference
11794 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
11796 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
11797 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
11798 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
11799 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
11800 is a symbolic link.
11801 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
11802 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
11804 @item --preserve-root
11805 @opindex --preserve-root
11806 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11807 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11808 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11809 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11811 @item --no-preserve-root
11812 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11813 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11814 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11815 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11817 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11818 @opindex --reference
11819 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
11820 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
11821 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
11827 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
11828 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
11829 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
11830 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
11831 its referent is being changed.
11836 @opindex --recursive
11837 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
11838 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
11841 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11844 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11845 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11848 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11857 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
11860 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
11865 @node chmod invocation
11866 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
11869 @cindex changing access permissions
11870 @cindex access permissions, changing
11871 @cindex permissions, changing access
11873 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
11876 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11880 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
11881 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
11882 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
11883 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
11884 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
11885 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
11886 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
11887 recursive directory traversals.
11889 Only a process whose effective user ID matches the user ID of the file,
11890 or a process with appropriate privileges, is permitted to change the
11891 file mode bits of a file.
11893 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
11894 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
11895 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
11896 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
11897 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
11898 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
11899 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
11900 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
11902 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
11903 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
11904 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
11905 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
11906 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
11907 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
11908 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
11910 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11918 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
11927 @cindex error messages, omitting
11928 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
11931 @item --preserve-root
11932 @opindex --preserve-root
11933 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11934 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11935 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11936 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11938 @item --no-preserve-root
11939 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11940 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11941 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11942 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11948 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
11950 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11951 @opindex --reference
11952 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
11953 @xref{File permissions}.
11954 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
11955 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
11960 @opindex --recursive
11961 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
11962 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
11971 # Change file permissions of FOO to be world readable
11972 # and user writable, with no other permissions.
11976 # Add user and group execute permissions to FOO.
11980 # Set file permissions of DIR and subsidiary files to
11981 # be the umask default, assuming execute permissions for
11982 # directories and for files already executable.
11983 chmod -R a=,+rwX dir
11987 @node touch invocation
11988 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
11991 @cindex changing file timestamps
11992 @cindex file timestamps, changing
11993 @cindex timestamps, changing file
11995 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification timestamps of the
11996 specified files. Synopsis:
11999 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
12002 @cindex empty files, creating
12003 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
12004 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
12005 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
12007 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
12008 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
12011 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
12012 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
12013 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
12015 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
12016 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
12017 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
12018 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
12019 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
12020 unless both the access and modification timestamps are being set to the
12023 The @command{touch} command cannot set a file's status change timestamp to
12024 a user-specified value, and cannot change the file's birth time (if
12025 supported) at all. Also, @command{touch} has issues similar to those
12026 affecting all programs that update file timestamps. For example,
12027 @command{touch} may set a file's timestamp to a value that differs
12028 slightly from the requested time. @xref{File timestamps}.
12031 Timestamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
12032 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
12033 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
12034 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12035 You can avoid ambiguities during
12036 daylight saving transitions by using UTC timestamps.
12038 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12043 @itemx --time=atime
12044 @itemx --time=access
12048 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
12049 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
12050 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
12051 Change the access timestamp only. @xref{File timestamps}.
12056 @opindex --no-create
12057 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
12059 @item -d @var{time}
12060 @itemx --date=@var{time}
12064 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
12065 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
12066 example, @option{--date="2020-07-21 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
12067 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
12068 July 21, 2020 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
12069 minutes east of UTC@. @xref{Date input formats}.
12070 File systems that do not support high-resolution timestamps
12071 silently ignore any excess precision here.
12075 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
12076 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
12079 @itemx --no-dereference
12081 @opindex --no-dereference
12082 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
12084 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
12085 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
12086 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
12087 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
12088 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
12089 action was not required until POSIX 2008. Also, on some
12090 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
12091 timestamp, such that only changes to the modification timestamp will persist
12092 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
12093 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
12097 @itemx --time=mtime
12098 @itemx --time=modify
12101 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
12102 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
12103 Change the modification timestamp only.
12105 @item -r @var{file}
12106 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
12108 @opindex --reference
12109 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
12110 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
12111 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
12112 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
12113 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a timestamp
12114 equal to five seconds before the corresponding timestamp for @file{foo}.
12115 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
12116 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
12118 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
12119 @cindex leap seconds
12120 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
12121 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
12122 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
12123 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
12124 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
12125 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
12126 On the atypical systems that support leap seconds, @var{ss} may be
12131 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
12132 On systems predating POSIX 1003.1-2001,
12133 @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
12134 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
12135 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
12136 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
12137 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
12138 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
12139 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
12140 for the other files instead of as a file name.
12141 Although this obsolete behavior can be controlled with the
12142 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
12143 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
12144 behavior depends on this variable.
12145 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
12146 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
12151 @node File space usage
12152 @chapter File space usage
12154 @cindex File space usage
12157 No file system can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
12158 how much storage is in use or available, report other file and
12159 file status information, and write buffers to file systems.
12162 * df invocation:: Report file system space usage.
12163 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
12164 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
12165 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage.
12166 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
12170 @node df invocation
12171 @section @command{df}: Report file system space usage
12174 @cindex file system usage
12175 @cindex disk usage by file system
12177 @command{df} reports the amount of space used and available on
12178 file systems. Synopsis:
12181 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12184 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
12185 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
12186 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
12188 Normally the space is printed in units of
12189 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
12190 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
12192 For bind mounts and without arguments, @command{df} only outputs the statistics
12193 for that device with the shortest mount point name in the list of file systems
12194 (@var{mtab}), i.e., it hides duplicate entries, unless the @option{-a} option is
12197 With the same logic, @command{df} elides a mount entry of a dummy pseudo device
12198 if there is another mount entry of a real block device for that mount point with
12199 the same device number, e.g. the early-boot pseudo file system @samp{rootfs} is
12200 not shown per default when already the real root device has been mounted.
12202 @cindex disk device file
12203 @cindex device file
12204 If an argument @var{file} resolves to a special file containing
12205 a mounted file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that
12206 file system rather than on the file system containing the device node.
12207 GNU @command{df} does not attempt to determine the usage
12208 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
12209 requires extremely non-portable intimate knowledge of file system structures.
12211 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12219 @cindex ignore file systems
12220 Include in the listing dummy, duplicate, or inaccessible file systems, which
12221 are omitted by default. Dummy file systems are typically special purpose
12222 pseudo file systems such as @samp{/proc}, with no associated storage.
12223 Duplicate file systems are local or remote file systems that are mounted
12224 at separate locations in the local file hierarchy, or bind mounted locations.
12225 Inaccessible file systems are those which are mounted but subsequently
12226 over-mounted by another file system at that point, or otherwise inaccessible
12227 due to permissions of the mount point etc.
12229 @item -B @var{size}
12230 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
12232 @opindex --block-size
12233 @cindex file system sizes
12234 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
12235 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
12241 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
12247 @cindex inode usage
12248 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
12249 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
12250 permissions, timestamps, and location on the file system.
12254 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
12255 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12256 (@pxref{Block size}).
12257 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
12263 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
12264 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
12269 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
12270 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
12271 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
12272 file systems, but on some systems (notably Solaris) the results may be slightly
12273 out of date. This is the default.
12276 @itemx --output[=@var{field_list}]
12278 Use the output format defined by @var{field_list}, or print all fields if
12279 @var{field_list} is omitted. In the latter case, the order of the columns
12280 conforms to the order of the field descriptions below.
12282 The use of the @option{--output} together with each of the options @option{-i},
12283 @option{-P}, and @option{-T} is mutually exclusive.
12285 FIELD_LIST is a comma-separated list of columns to be included in @command{df}'s
12286 output and therefore effectively controls the order of output columns.
12287 Each field can thus be used at the place of choice, but yet must only be
12290 Valid field names in the @var{field_list} are:
12293 The source of the mount point, usually a device.
12298 Total number of inodes.
12300 Number of used inodes.
12302 Number of available inodes.
12304 Percentage of @var{iused} divided by @var{itotal}.
12307 Total number of blocks.
12309 Number of used blocks.
12311 Number of available blocks.
12313 Percentage of @var{used} divided by @var{size}.
12316 The file name if specified on the command line.
12321 The fields for block and inodes statistics are affected by the scaling
12322 options like @option{-h} as usual.
12324 The definition of the @var{field_list} can even be split among several
12325 @option{--output} uses.
12329 # Print the TARGET (i.e., the mount point) along with their percentage
12330 # statistic regarding the blocks and the inodes.
12331 df --out=target --output=pcent,ipcent
12333 # Print all available fields.
12339 @itemx --portability
12341 @opindex --portability
12342 @cindex one-line output format
12343 @cindex POSIX output format
12344 @cindex portable output format
12345 @cindex output format, portable
12346 Use the POSIX output format. This is like the default format except
12351 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
12352 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
12353 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
12354 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
12357 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to POSIX.
12360 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
12361 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
12362 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
12363 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
12364 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
12371 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
12372 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
12373 some systems (notably Solaris), doing this yields more up to date results,
12374 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
12375 there are many or very busy file systems.
12379 @cindex grand total of file system size, usage and available space
12380 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
12381 been processed. This can be used to find out the total size, usage
12382 and available space of all listed devices. If no arguments are specified
12383 df will try harder to elide file systems insignificant to the total
12384 available space, by suppressing duplicate remote file systems.
12386 For the grand total line, @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the
12387 @var{source} column, and @samp{"-"} into the @var{target} column.
12388 If there is no @var{source} column (see @option{--output}), then
12389 @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the @var{target} column,
12392 @item -t @var{fstype}
12393 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
12396 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
12397 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
12398 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
12399 By default, nothing is omitted.
12402 @itemx --print-type
12404 @opindex --print-type
12405 @cindex file system types, printing
12406 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
12407 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
12408 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
12409 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
12414 @cindex NFS file system type
12415 An NFS file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
12416 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
12419 @item ext2@r{, }ext3@r{, }ext4@r{, }xfs@r{, }btrfs@dots{}
12420 @cindex Linux file system types
12421 @cindex local file system types
12422 @opindex ext2 @r{file system type}
12423 @opindex ext3 @r{file system type}
12424 @opindex ext4 @r{file system type}
12425 @opindex xfs @r{file system type}
12426 @opindex btrfs @r{file system type}
12427 A file system on a locally-mounted device. (The system might even
12428 support more than one type here; GNU/Linux does.)
12430 @item iso9660@r{, }cdfs
12431 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
12432 @cindex DVD file system type
12433 @cindex ISO9660 file system type
12434 @opindex iso9660 @r{file system type}
12435 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
12436 A file system on a CD or DVD drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
12437 systems use @samp{iso9660}.
12440 @cindex NTFS file system
12441 @cindex DOS file system
12442 @cindex MS-DOS file system
12443 @cindex MS-Windows file system
12444 @opindex ntfs @r{file system file}
12445 @opindex fat @r{file system file}
12446 File systems used by MS-Windows / MS-DOS.
12450 @item -x @var{fstype}
12451 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
12453 @opindex --exclude-type
12454 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
12455 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
12456 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
12459 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
12463 @command{df} is installed only on systems that have usable mount tables,
12464 so portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
12467 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
12468 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
12469 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
12470 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
12472 Since the list of file systems (@var{mtab}) is needed to determine the
12473 file system type, failure includes the cases when that list cannot
12474 be read and one or more of the options @option{-a}, @option{-l}, @option{-t}
12475 or @option{-x} is used together with a file name argument.
12478 @node du invocation
12479 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
12482 @cindex file space usage
12483 @cindex disk usage for files
12485 @command{du} reports the space needed to represent a set of files.
12489 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12492 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the space needed to represent
12493 the files at or under the current directory.
12494 Normally the space is printed in units of
12495 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
12496 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
12498 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
12499 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
12500 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
12501 and entries that @command{du} outputs.
12503 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12513 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
12515 @item --apparent-size
12516 @opindex --apparent-size
12517 Print apparent sizes, rather than file system usage. The apparent size of a
12518 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
12519 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
12520 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
12521 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
12522 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of file system space, depending on
12523 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
12524 However, a sparse file created with this command:
12527 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
12531 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
12532 file systems, it actually uses almost no space.
12534 Apparent sizes are meaningful only for regular files and symbolic links.
12535 Other file types do not contribute to apparent size.
12537 @item -B @var{size}
12538 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
12540 @opindex --block-size
12542 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
12543 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
12549 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
12555 @cindex grand total of file system space
12556 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
12557 been processed. This can be used to find out the total file system usage of
12558 a given set of files or directories.
12561 @itemx --dereference-args
12563 @opindex --dereference-args
12564 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
12565 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
12566 out the file system usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
12567 are often symbolic links.
12569 @item -d @var{depth}
12570 @itemx --max-depth=@var{depth}
12571 @opindex -d @var{depth}
12572 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
12573 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
12574 Show the total for each directory (and file if @option{--all}) that is at
12575 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
12576 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
12578 @c --files0-from=FILE
12579 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
12583 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
12589 @cindex inode usage, dereferencing in @command{du}
12590 List inode usage information instead of block usage.
12591 This option is useful for finding directories which contain many files, and
12592 therefore eat up most of the inodes space of a file system (see @command{df},
12593 option @option{--inodes}).
12594 It can well be combined with the options @option{-a}, @option{-c},
12595 @option{-h}, @option{-l}, @option{-s}, @option{-S}, @option{-t} and
12596 @option{-x}; however, passing other options regarding the block size, for
12597 example @option{-b}, @option{-m} and @option{--apparent-size}, is ignored.
12601 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
12602 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12603 (@pxref{Block size}).
12604 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
12607 @itemx --dereference
12609 @opindex --dereference
12610 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
12611 Dereference symbolic links (show the file system space used by the file
12612 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
12616 @itemx --count-links
12618 @opindex --count-links
12619 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
12620 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
12625 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
12626 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12627 (@pxref{Block size}).
12628 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
12631 @itemx --no-dereference
12633 @opindex --no-dereference
12634 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
12635 For each symbolic link encountered by @command{du},
12636 consider the file system space used by the symbolic link itself.
12639 @itemx --separate-dirs
12641 @opindex --separate-dirs
12642 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
12643 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
12644 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
12645 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
12646 @var{d}, will exclude the size of any subdirectories.
12653 @opindex --summarize
12654 Display only a total for each argument.
12656 @item -t @var{size}
12657 @itemx --threshold=@var{size}
12659 @opindex --threshold
12660 Exclude entries based on a given @var{size}. The @var{size} refers to used
12661 blocks in normal mode (@pxref{Block size}), or inodes count in conjunction
12662 with the @option{--inodes} option.
12664 If @var{size} is positive, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
12665 greater than or equal to that.
12667 If @var{size} is negative, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
12668 smaller than or equal to that.
12670 Although GNU @command{find} can be used to find files of a certain size,
12671 @command{du}'s @option{--threshold} option can be used to also filter
12672 directories based on a given size.
12674 When combined with the @option{--apparent-size} option, the
12675 @option{--threshold} option elides entries based on apparent size.
12676 When combined with the @option{--inodes} option, it elides entries
12677 based on inode counts.
12679 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories with a size
12680 greater than or equal to 200 megabytes:
12683 du --threshold=200MB
12686 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories and
12687 files -- note the @option{-a} -- with an apparent size smaller than or
12688 equal to 500 bytes:
12691 du -a -t -500 --apparent-size
12694 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories on the root
12695 file system with more than 20000 inodes used in the directory tree below:
12698 du --inodes -x --threshold=20000 /
12704 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
12705 Show the most recent modification timestamp (mtime) of any file in the
12706 directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12709 @itemx --time=status
12712 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
12713 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
12714 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
12715 Show the most recent status change timestamp (ctime) of any file in
12716 the directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12719 @itemx --time=access
12721 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
12722 @opindex access timestamp@r{, show the most recent}
12723 Show the most recent access timestamp (atime) of any file in the
12724 directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12726 @item --time-style=@var{style}
12727 @opindex --time-style
12729 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
12730 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
12731 be one of the following:
12734 @item +@var{format}
12736 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
12737 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
12738 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
12739 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2020-07-21 23:45:56}. As
12740 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
12741 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12744 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601-like date, time, and time zone
12745 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21
12746 23:45:56.477817180 -0400}. This style is equivalent to
12747 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
12750 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
12751 @samp{2020-07-21 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
12752 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
12753 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
12756 List ISO 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21}.
12757 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
12761 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
12762 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
12763 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
12764 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
12765 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
12766 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
12767 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
12769 @item -X @var{file}
12770 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
12771 @opindex -X @var{file}
12772 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
12773 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
12774 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
12775 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
12778 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
12779 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
12780 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
12781 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
12782 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
12786 @itemx --one-file-system
12788 @opindex --one-file-system
12789 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
12790 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
12791 the argument being processed is on.
12795 Since @command{du} relies on information reported by the operating
12796 system, its output might not reflect the space consumed in the
12797 underlying devices. For example;
12801 Operating systems normally do not report device space consumed by
12802 duplicate or backup blocks, error correction bits, and so forth.
12803 This causes @command{du} to underestimate the device space actually used.
12806 @cindex copy-on-write and @command{du}
12807 In file systems that use copy-on-write, if two distinct files share
12808 space the output of @command{du} typically counts the space that would
12809 be consumed if all files' non-holes were rewritten, not the space
12810 currently consumed.
12813 @cindex compression and @command{du}
12814 In file systems that use compression, the operating system might
12815 report the uncompressed space. (If it does report the compressed space,
12816 that report might change after one merely overwrites existing file data.)
12819 @cindex networked file systems and @command{du}
12820 Networked file systems historically have had difficulty communicating
12821 accurate file system information from server to client.
12825 For these reasons @command{du} might better be thought of as an
12826 estimate of the size of a @command{tar} or other conventional backup
12827 for a set of files, rather than as a measure of space consumed in the
12828 underlying devices.
12833 @node stat invocation
12834 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
12837 @cindex file status
12838 @cindex file system status
12840 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
12843 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12846 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
12847 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
12848 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
12849 also give information about the files the links point to.
12851 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
12856 @itemx --dereference
12858 @opindex --dereference
12859 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
12860 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
12861 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
12862 by each symbolic link argument.
12863 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
12866 @itemx --file-system
12868 @opindex --file-system
12869 @cindex file systems
12870 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
12871 instead of information about the files themselves.
12872 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
12874 @item --cached=@var{mode}
12875 @opindex --cached=@var{mode}
12876 @cindex attribute caching
12877 Control how attributes are read from the file system;
12878 if supported by the system. This allows one to
12879 control the trade-off between freshness and efficiency
12880 of attribute access, especially useful with remote file systems.
12885 Always read the already cached attributes if available.
12888 Always synchronize with the latest file system attributes.
12889 This also mounts automounted files.
12892 Leave the caching behavior to the underlying file system.
12897 @itemx --format=@var{format}
12899 @opindex --format=@var{format}
12900 @cindex output format
12901 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
12902 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
12903 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
12904 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
12906 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
12911 @item --printf=@var{format}
12912 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
12913 @cindex output format
12914 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
12915 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
12916 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
12917 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
12918 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
12919 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
12921 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
12930 @cindex terse output
12931 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
12933 The output of the following commands are identical and the @option{--format}
12934 also identifies the items printed (in fuller form) in the default format.
12935 Note the format string would include another @samp{%C} at the end with an
12936 active SELinux security context.
12938 $ stat --format="%n %s %b %f %u %g %D %i %h %t %T %X %Y %Z %W %o" ...
12942 The same illustrating terse output in @option{--file-system} mode:
12944 $ stat -f --format="%n %i %l %t %s %S %b %f %a %c %d" ...
12945 $ stat -f --terse ...
12949 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
12950 @option{--printf} are:
12953 @item %a -- Permission bits in octal (note @samp{#} and @samp{0} printf flags)
12954 @item %A -- Permission bits in symbolic form (similar to @command{ls -ld})
12955 @item %b -- Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
12956 @item %B -- The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
12957 @item %C -- The SELinux security context of a file, if available
12958 @item %d -- Device number in decimal (st_dev)
12959 @item %D -- Device number in hex (st_dev)
12960 @item %Hd -- Major device number in decimal
12961 @item %Ld -- Minor device number in decimal
12962 @item %f -- Raw mode in hex
12963 @item %F -- File type
12964 @item %g -- Group ID of owner
12965 @item %G -- Group name of owner
12966 @item %h -- Number of hard links
12967 @item %i -- Inode number
12968 @item %m -- Mount point (See note below)
12969 @item %n -- File name
12970 @item %N -- Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link (see below)
12971 @item %o -- Optimal I/O transfer size hint
12972 @item %s -- Total size, in bytes
12973 @item %r -- Device type in decimal (st_rdev)
12974 @item %R -- Device type in hex (st_rdev)
12975 @item %Hr -- Major device type in decimal (see below)
12976 @item %Lr -- Minor device type in decimal (see below)
12977 @item %t -- Major device type in hex (see below)
12978 @item %T -- Minor device type in hex (see below)
12979 @item %u -- User ID of owner
12980 @item %U -- User name of owner
12981 @item %w -- Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
12982 @item %W -- Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
12983 @item %x -- Time of last access
12984 @item %X -- Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
12985 @item %y -- Time of last data modification
12986 @item %Y -- Time of last data modification as seconds since Epoch
12987 @item %z -- Time of last status change
12988 @item %Z -- Time of last status change as seconds since Epoch
12991 The @samp{%a} format prints the octal mode, and so it is useful
12992 to control the zero padding of the output with the @samp{#} and @samp{0}
12993 printf flags. For example to pad to at least 3 wide while making larger
12994 numbers unambiguously octal, you can use @samp{%#03a}.
12996 The @samp{%N} format can be set with the environment variable
12997 @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment variable is not set,
12998 the default value is @samp{shell-escape-always}. Valid quoting styles are:
13001 The @samp{r}, @samp{R}, @samp{%t}, and @samp{%T} formats operate on the st_rdev
13002 member of the stat(2) structure, i.e., the represented device rather than
13003 the containing device, and so are only defined for character and block
13004 special files. On some systems or file types, st_rdev may be used to
13005 represent other quantities.
13007 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
13008 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
13009 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
13010 access timestamp to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
13011 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
13012 @samp{%.9X}@. When discarding excess precision, timestamps are truncated
13013 toward minus infinity.
13017 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
13020 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
13022 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
13025 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
13027 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
13028 [1288929712.114951834]
13031 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
13032 by @command{df}, except that:
13035 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
13036 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
13038 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
13039 file system list, instead operating on them directly
13042 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
13043 the initial mount point of its backing device.
13044 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
13045 to get the current base mount point
13048 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
13049 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
13052 @item %a -- Free blocks available to non-super-user
13053 @item %b -- Total data blocks in file system
13054 @item %c -- Total file nodes in file system
13055 @item %d -- Free file nodes in file system
13056 @item %f -- Free blocks in file system
13057 @item %i -- File System ID in hex
13058 @item %l -- Maximum length of file names
13059 @item %n -- File name
13060 @item %s -- Block size (for faster transfers)
13061 @item %S -- Fundamental block size (for block counts)
13062 @item %t -- Type in hex
13063 @item %T -- Type in human readable form
13067 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
13068 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
13069 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
13070 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
13075 @node sync invocation
13076 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
13079 @cindex synchronize file system and memory
13080 @cindex Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
13082 @command{sync} synchronizes in memory files or file systems to persistent
13086 sync [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
13089 @cindex superblock, writing
13090 @cindex inodes, written buffered
13091 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to the storage device.
13093 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
13094 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
13095 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync},
13096 @code{syncfs}, @code{fsync}, and @code{fdatasync} system calls.
13098 @cindex crashes and corruption
13099 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) device
13100 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
13101 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
13102 result. The @command{sync} command instructs the kernel to write
13103 data in memory to persistent storage.
13105 If any argument is specified then only those files will be
13106 synchronized using the fsync(2) syscall by default.
13108 If at least one file is specified, it is possible to change the
13109 synchronization method with the following options. Also see
13110 @ref{Common options}.
13116 Use fdatasync(2) to sync only the data for the file,
13117 and any metadata required to maintain file system consistency.
13120 @itemx --file-system
13121 @opindex --file-system
13122 Synchronize all the I/O waiting for the file systems that contain the file,
13123 using the syscall syncfs(2). Note you would usually @emph{not} specify
13124 this option if passing a device node like @samp{/dev/sda} for example,
13125 as that would sync the containing file system rather than the referenced one.
13126 Note also that depending on the system, passing individual device nodes or files
13127 may have different sync characteristics than using no arguments.
13128 I.e., arguments passed to fsync(2) may provide greater guarantees through
13129 write barriers, than a global sync(2) used when no arguments are provided.
13135 @node truncate invocation
13136 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
13139 @cindex truncating, file sizes
13141 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
13142 specified size. Synopsis:
13145 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
13148 @cindex files, creating
13149 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
13151 @cindex sparse files, creating
13152 @cindex holes, creating files with
13153 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
13154 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the sparse extended part
13155 (or hole) reads as zero bytes.
13157 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13164 @opindex --no-create
13165 Do not create files that do not exist.
13170 @opindex --io-blocks
13171 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
13173 @item -r @var{rfile}
13174 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
13176 @opindex --reference
13177 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
13179 @item -s @var{size}
13180 @itemx --size=@var{size}
13183 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
13184 @var{size} is in bytes unless @option{--io-blocks} is specified.
13185 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
13187 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
13188 the size of each @var{file} based on its current size:
13190 @samp{+} => extend by
13191 @samp{-} => reduce by
13192 @samp{<} => at most
13193 @samp{>} => at least
13194 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
13195 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
13203 @node Printing text
13204 @chapter Printing text
13206 @cindex printing text, commands for
13207 @cindex commands for printing text
13209 This section describes commands that display text strings.
13212 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
13213 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
13214 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
13218 @node echo invocation
13219 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
13222 @cindex displaying text
13223 @cindex printing text
13224 @cindex text, displaying
13225 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
13227 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
13228 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
13231 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
13234 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
13236 Due to historical and backwards compatibility reasons, certain bare option-like
13237 strings cannot be passed to @command{echo} as non-option arguments.
13238 It is therefore not advisable to use @command{echo} for printing unknown or
13239 variable arguments. The @command{printf} command is recommended as a more
13240 portable and flexible replacement for tasks historically performed by
13241 @command{echo}. @xref{printf invocation}.
13243 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13244 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
13245 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
13251 Do not output the trailing newline.
13255 @cindex backslash escapes
13256 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
13265 produce no further output
13281 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
13282 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
13283 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
13285 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
13286 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
13287 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
13289 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
13290 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
13295 @cindex backslash escapes
13296 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
13297 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
13298 specified, the last one given takes effect.
13302 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13303 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
13304 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
13305 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
13306 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
13307 plain @samp{hello}. Also backslash escapes are always enabled.
13308 Note to echo the string @samp{-n}, one of the characters
13309 can be escaped in either octal or hexadecimal representation.
13310 For example, @code{echo -e '\x2dn'}.
13312 POSIX does not require support for any options, and says
13313 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
13314 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is @option{-n}.
13315 Portable programs should use the @command{printf} command instead.
13316 @xref{printf invocation}.
13321 @node printf invocation
13322 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
13325 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
13328 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
13331 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
13332 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
13333 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
13334 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
13335 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
13336 The differences are listed below.
13338 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
13343 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
13344 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
13348 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
13349 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
13350 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
13354 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
13355 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
13356 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
13359 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
13360 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
13361 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
13362 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
13367 An additional directive @samp{%b}, prints its
13368 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
13369 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
13370 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
13371 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
13372 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
13373 from the converted string.
13377 An additional directive @samp{%q}, prints its argument string
13378 in a format that can be reused as input by most shells.
13379 Non-printable characters are escaped with the POSIX proposed @samp{$''} syntax,
13380 and shell metacharacters are quoted appropriately.
13381 This is an equivalent format to @command{ls --quoting=shell-escape} output.
13384 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
13385 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
13389 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13390 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
13391 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
13392 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
13393 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
13394 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
13395 @samp{97} on hosts that use the ASCII character set, since
13396 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in ASCII.
13401 A floating point argument is interpreted according to
13402 the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of either the current or the C locale,
13403 and is printed according to the current locale.
13404 For example, in a locale whose decimal point character is a comma,
13405 the command @samp{printf '%g %g' 2,5 2.5} outputs @samp{2,5 2,5}.
13406 @xref{Floating point}.
13410 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
13411 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
13412 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
13413 digits) specifying a character to print.
13414 Note however that when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
13415 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
13416 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
13421 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
13423 @command{printf} interprets two syntax forms for specifying Unicode
13424 (ISO/IEC 10646) characters.
13425 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode characters, specified as
13426 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
13427 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
13428 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
13429 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the range
13430 U+D800@dots{}U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax.
13431 This syntax fully supports the universal character subset
13432 introduced in ISO C 99.
13434 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
13435 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
13436 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
13437 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
13439 Unicode character syntax is useful for writing strings in a locale
13440 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
13443 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
13447 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
13448 (ISO-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
13451 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
13455 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
13457 Note that in these examples, the @command{printf} command has been
13458 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
13459 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
13461 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
13462 values of each character one by one. ASCII characters mixed with \u
13463 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
13464 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
13465 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
13466 this text in a locale-independent way:
13469 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_TW.big5 env printf \
13470 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
13471 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
13472 | sed -e "s|^|env printf '|" -e "s|%|%%|g" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
13476 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
13477 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
13478 Options must precede operands.
13483 @node yes invocation
13484 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
13487 @cindex repeated output of a string
13489 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
13490 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
13491 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
13493 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
13495 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
13496 To output an argument that begins with
13497 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
13498 @xref{Common options}.
13502 @chapter Conditions
13505 @cindex commands for exit status
13506 @cindex exit status commands
13508 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
13509 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
13510 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
13514 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
13515 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
13516 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
13517 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
13521 @node false invocation
13522 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
13525 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
13526 @cindex failure exit status
13527 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
13529 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
13530 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
13531 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
13532 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
13533 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
13534 command, not the one documented here.
13536 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
13538 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
13539 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
13540 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
13542 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
13543 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
13544 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
13546 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
13547 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
13551 @node true invocation
13552 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
13555 @cindex do nothing, successfully
13557 @cindex successful exit
13558 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
13560 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
13561 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
13562 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
13563 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
13564 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
13565 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
13566 command, not the one documented here.
13568 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
13570 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
13571 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
13572 option, and with standard
13573 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
13574 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
13577 $ ./true --version >&-
13578 ./true: write error: Bad file number
13579 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
13580 ./true: write error: No space left on device
13583 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
13584 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
13585 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
13587 @node test invocation
13588 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
13591 @cindex check file types
13592 @cindex compare values
13593 @cindex expression evaluation
13595 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
13596 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
13597 expression must be a separate argument.
13599 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
13600 comparison operators.
13602 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
13603 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
13604 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
13605 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
13606 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
13607 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
13613 test @var{expression}
13615 [ @var{expression} ]
13620 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
13622 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
13623 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
13624 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
13625 otherwise. The argument
13626 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
13627 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
13628 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
13629 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
13630 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
13632 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
13636 0 if the expression is true,
13637 1 if the expression is false,
13638 2 if an error occurred.
13642 * File type tests:: @code{-[bcdfhLpSt]}
13643 * Access permission tests:: @code{-[gkruwxOG]}
13644 * File characteristic tests:: @code{-e -s -nt -ot -ef}
13645 * String tests:: @code{-z -n = == !=}
13646 * Numeric tests:: @code{-eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge}
13647 * Connectives for test:: @code{! -a -o}
13651 @node File type tests
13652 @subsection File type tests
13654 @cindex file type tests
13656 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
13657 but not all files are the same!)
13661 @item -b @var{file}
13663 @cindex block special check
13664 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
13666 @item -c @var{file}
13668 @cindex character special check
13669 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
13671 @item -d @var{file}
13673 @cindex directory check
13674 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
13676 @item -f @var{file}
13678 @cindex regular file check
13679 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
13681 @item -h @var{file}
13682 @itemx -L @var{file}
13685 @cindex symbolic link check
13686 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
13687 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
13688 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
13690 @item -p @var{file}
13692 @cindex named pipe check
13693 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
13695 @item -S @var{file}
13697 @cindex socket check
13698 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
13702 @cindex terminal check
13703 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
13709 @node Access permission tests
13710 @subsection Access permission tests
13712 @cindex access permission tests
13713 @cindex permission tests
13715 These options test for particular access permissions.
13719 @item -g @var{file}
13721 @cindex set-group-ID check
13722 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
13724 @item -k @var{file}
13726 @cindex sticky bit check
13727 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
13729 @item -r @var{file}
13731 @cindex readable file check
13732 True if @var{file} exists and the user has read access.
13734 @item -u @var{file}
13736 @cindex set-user-ID check
13737 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
13739 @item -w @var{file}
13741 @cindex writable file check
13742 True if @var{file} exists and the user has write access.
13744 @item -x @var{file}
13746 @cindex executable file check
13747 True if @var{file} exists and the user has execute access
13748 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
13750 @item -O @var{file}
13752 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
13753 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
13755 @item -G @var{file}
13757 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
13758 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
13762 @node File characteristic tests
13763 @subsection File characteristic tests
13765 @cindex file characteristic tests
13767 These options test other file characteristics.
13771 @item -e @var{file}
13773 @cindex existence-of-file check
13774 True if @var{file} exists.
13776 @item -s @var{file}
13778 @cindex nonempty file check
13779 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
13781 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
13783 @cindex newer-than file check
13784 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
13785 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
13787 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
13789 @cindex older-than file check
13790 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
13791 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
13793 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
13795 @cindex same file check
13796 @cindex hard link check
13797 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
13798 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
13800 @item -N @var{file}
13802 @cindex mtime-greater-atime file check
13803 True if @var{file} exists and has been modified (mtime) since it was
13810 @subsection String tests
13812 @cindex string tests
13814 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
13815 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
13821 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
13822 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
13826 @item -z @var{string}
13828 @cindex zero-length string check
13829 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
13831 @item -n @var{string}
13832 @itemx @var{string}
13834 @cindex nonzero-length string check
13835 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
13837 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
13839 @cindex equal string check
13840 True if the strings are equal.
13842 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
13844 @cindex equal string check
13845 True if the strings are equal (synonym for =).
13846 Note this form is not as portable to other
13847 shells and systems.
13849 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
13851 @cindex not-equal string check
13852 True if the strings are not equal.
13857 @node Numeric tests
13858 @subsection Numeric tests
13860 @cindex numeric tests
13861 @cindex arithmetic tests
13863 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
13864 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
13865 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
13869 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
13870 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
13871 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
13872 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
13873 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
13874 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
13881 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
13882 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
13883 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
13890 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
13892 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
13895 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
13899 @node Connectives for test
13900 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
13902 @cindex logical connectives
13903 @cindex connectives, logical
13905 Note it's preferred to use shell logical primitives
13906 rather than these logical connectives internal to @command{test},
13907 because an expression may become ambiguous
13908 depending on the expansion of its parameters.
13910 For example, this becomes ambiguous when @samp{$1}
13911 is set to @samp{'!'} and @samp{$2} to the empty string @samp{''}:
13917 and should be written as:
13920 test "$1" && test "$2"
13923 Note the shell logical primitives also benefit from
13924 short circuit operation, which can be significant
13925 for file attribute tests.
13931 True if @var{expr} is false.
13932 @samp{!} has lower precedence than all parts of @var{expr}.
13933 Note @samp{!} needs to be specified to the left
13934 of a binary expression, I.e., @samp{'!' 1 -gt 2}
13935 rather than @samp{1 '!' -gt 2}.
13936 Also @samp{!} is often a shell special character
13937 and is best used quoted.
13940 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
13942 @cindex logical and operator
13943 @cindex and operator
13944 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
13945 @samp{-a} is left associative,
13946 and has a higher precedence than @samp{-o}.
13948 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
13950 @cindex logical or operator
13951 @cindex or operator
13952 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
13953 @samp{-o} is left associative.
13958 @node expr invocation
13959 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
13962 @cindex expression evaluation
13963 @cindex evaluation of expressions
13965 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
13966 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
13968 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
13969 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
13970 @command{expr} converts
13971 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
13972 depending on the operation being applied to it.
13974 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
13975 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
13976 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
13977 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
13978 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
13979 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
13980 work around this is to use the GNU extension @code{+},
13981 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
13982 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
13983 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
13985 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
13986 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
13987 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
13988 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
13989 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
13990 leading spaces as mentioned above.
13992 @cindex parentheses for grouping
13993 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
13994 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
13995 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
13998 Because @command{expr} uses multiple-precision arithmetic, it works
13999 with integers wider than those of machine registers.
14001 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14002 options}. Options must precede operands.
14004 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
14008 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
14009 1 if the expression is null or 0,
14010 2 if the expression is invalid,
14011 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
14015 * String expressions:: @code{+ : match substr index length}
14016 * Numeric expressions:: @code{+ - * / %}
14017 * Relations for expr:: @code{| & < <= = == != >= >}
14018 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
14022 @node String expressions
14023 @subsection String expressions
14025 @cindex string expressions
14026 @cindex expressions, string
14028 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
14029 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
14030 the next sections).
14034 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
14035 @cindex pattern matching
14036 @cindex regular expression matching
14037 @cindex matching patterns
14038 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
14039 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
14040 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
14041 then matched against this regular expression.
14043 If @var{regex} does not use @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the @code{:}
14044 expression returns the number of characters matched, or 0 if the match
14047 If @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the @code{:} expression
14048 returns the part of @var{string} that matched the subexpression, or
14049 the null string if the match failed or the subexpression did not
14050 contribute to the match.
14052 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
14053 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
14054 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
14055 expression operators.
14057 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
14058 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
14059 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
14060 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
14061 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
14062 alternatives. These operators are GNU extensions. @xref{Regular Expressions,,
14063 Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}, for details of
14064 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
14066 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
14068 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
14069 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
14071 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
14073 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
14074 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
14075 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
14077 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
14079 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
14080 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
14081 @var{string}, return 0.
14083 @item length @var{string}
14085 Returns the length of @var{string}.
14087 @item + @var{token}
14089 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
14090 or an operator like @code{/}.
14091 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
14092 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
14093 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
14094 This operator is a GNU extension. Portable shell scripts should use
14095 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
14099 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
14100 @code{quote} operator.
14103 @node Numeric expressions
14104 @subsection Numeric expressions
14106 @cindex numeric expressions
14107 @cindex expressions, numeric
14109 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
14110 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
14111 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
14112 than the connectives (next section).
14120 @cindex subtraction
14121 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
14122 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
14128 @cindex multiplication
14131 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
14132 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
14137 @node Relations for expr
14138 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
14140 @cindex connectives, logical
14141 @cindex logical connectives
14142 @cindex relations, numeric or string
14144 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
14145 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
14146 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
14152 @cindex logical or operator
14153 @cindex or operator
14154 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
14155 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
14156 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
14161 @cindex logical and operator
14162 @cindex and operator
14163 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
14164 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
14167 @item < <= = == != >= >
14174 @cindex comparison operators
14176 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
14177 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
14178 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
14179 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
14180 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
14185 @node Examples of expr
14186 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
14188 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
14189 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
14191 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
14194 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
14197 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
14198 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
14201 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
14204 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
14212 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
14214 expr index abcdef cz
14217 @error{} expr: syntax error
14218 expr index + index a
14224 @chapter Redirection
14226 @cindex redirection
14227 @cindex commands for redirection
14229 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection} -- ways
14230 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
14231 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
14232 it's described here.
14235 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
14239 @node tee invocation
14240 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
14243 @cindex pipe fitting
14244 @cindex destinations, multiple output
14245 @cindex read from standard input and write to standard output and files
14247 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
14248 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
14249 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
14252 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
14255 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
14256 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
14257 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
14259 In previous versions of GNU Coreutils (5.3.0--8.23),
14260 a @var{file} of @samp{-}
14261 caused @command{tee} to send another copy of input to standard output.
14262 However, as the interleaved output was not very useful, @command{tee} now
14263 conforms to POSIX and treats @samp{-} as a file name.
14265 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14272 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
14276 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
14278 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
14279 Ignore interrupt signals.
14282 @itemx --output-error[=@var{mode}]
14284 @opindex --output-error
14285 Adjust the behavior with errors on the outputs.
14286 In summary @option{-p} allows @command{tee} to operate in a more
14287 appropriate manner with pipes, and to continue to process data
14288 to any remaining outputs, if any pipe outputs exit early.
14289 The default operation when @option{--output-error} is @emph{not}
14290 specified is to exit immediately on error writing to a pipe,
14291 and diagnose errors writing to a non-pipe.
14292 The long form @option{--output-error} option supports selection
14293 between the following @var{mode}s:
14297 Warn on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
14298 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
14299 Exit status indicates failure if any output has an error.
14302 This is the default @var{mode} when not specified,
14303 or when the short form @option{-p} is used.
14304 Warn on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
14305 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
14306 Exit immediately if all remaining outputs become broken pipes.
14307 Exit status indicates failure if any non pipe output had an error.
14310 Exit on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
14313 Exit on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
14314 Exit immediately if all remaining outputs become broken pipes.
14319 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
14320 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
14321 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
14322 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
14323 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
14326 wget https://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
14329 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
14330 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
14331 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
14332 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
14334 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
14335 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
14336 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
14339 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
14340 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14341 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
14344 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
14345 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
14346 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
14348 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
14349 called @dfn{process substitution}
14350 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
14351 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bash,
14352 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
14353 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
14354 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
14355 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
14357 Note also that if any of the process substitutions (or piped standard output)
14358 might exit early without consuming all the data, the @option{-p} option
14359 is needed to allow @command{tee} to continue to process the input
14360 to any remaining outputs.
14362 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
14363 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
14366 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14367 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
14370 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
14371 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
14372 process substitution is required:
14375 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14376 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
14377 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
14381 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
14382 copy of the contents of a pipe.
14383 Consider a tool to graphically summarize file system usage data from
14385 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
14386 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
14387 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
14388 the uncompressed output.
14390 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
14391 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
14394 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
14395 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | checkspace -a
14398 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
14399 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
14402 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | checkspace -a
14405 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
14406 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
14407 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
14408 there may be a better way.
14409 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
14410 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
14411 (slightly simplified):
14414 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14415 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
14416 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
14419 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
14420 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
14421 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
14422 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
14425 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14426 tar chof - "$tardir" \
14427 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
14428 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
14431 If you want to further process the output from process substitutions,
14432 and those processes write atomically (i.e., write less than the system's
14433 PIPE_BUF size at a time), that's possible with a construct like:
14436 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14437 tar chof - "$tardir" \
14438 | tee >(md5sum --tag) > >(sha256sum --tag) \
14439 | sort | gpg --clearsign > your-pkg-M.N.tar.sig
14445 @node File name manipulation
14446 @chapter File name manipulation
14448 @cindex file name manipulation
14449 @cindex manipulation of file names
14450 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
14452 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
14455 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
14456 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
14457 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
14458 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
14459 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
14463 @node basename invocation
14464 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
14467 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
14468 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
14469 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
14470 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
14471 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
14473 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
14474 @var{name}. Synopsis:
14477 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
14478 basename @var{option}@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
14481 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
14482 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
14483 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
14484 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
14487 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
14488 @macro basenameAndDirname
14489 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
14490 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
14491 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
14492 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
14494 @basenameAndDirname
14496 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
14497 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, GNU
14498 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
14499 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
14500 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
14502 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14503 Options must precede operands.
14510 @opindex --multiple
14511 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
14512 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
14513 @option{-s} option.
14515 @item -s @var{suffix}
14516 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
14519 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
14520 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
14532 basename /usr/bin/sort
14535 basename include/stdio.h .h
14538 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
14540 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
14541 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
14545 @node dirname invocation
14546 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
14549 @cindex directory components, printing
14550 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
14551 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
14553 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
14554 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
14555 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
14556 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
14559 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
14562 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
14563 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
14564 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
14566 @basenameAndDirname
14568 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
14569 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With GNU @command{dirname}, the
14570 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
14571 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
14573 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14586 # Output "/usr/bin".
14587 dirname /usr/bin/sort
14588 dirname /usr/bin//.//
14590 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
14591 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
14598 @node pathchk invocation
14599 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
14602 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
14603 @cindex valid file names, checking for
14604 @cindex portable file names, checking for
14606 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
14609 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
14612 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
14613 these conditions is true:
14617 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
14618 (execute) permission,
14620 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
14623 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
14624 its file system's maximum.
14627 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long as a file with that
14628 name could be created under the above conditions.
14630 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14631 Options must precede operands.
14637 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
14638 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
14642 A file name is empty.
14645 A file name contains a character outside the POSIX portable file
14646 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
14647 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
14650 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
14651 POSIX minimum limits for portability.
14656 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
14657 that begins with @samp{-}.
14659 @item --portability
14660 @opindex --portability
14661 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all POSIX
14662 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
14666 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
14670 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
14674 @node mktemp invocation
14675 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
14678 @cindex file names, creating temporary
14679 @cindex directory, creating temporary
14680 @cindex temporary files and directories
14682 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
14683 directories. Synopsis:
14686 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
14689 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
14690 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
14691 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
14692 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
14693 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
14694 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
14695 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
14696 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
14698 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
14699 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
14700 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
14701 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
14702 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
14703 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
14704 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
14705 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
14706 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
14707 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
14708 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
14709 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
14710 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
14712 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
14713 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
14714 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
14717 Here are some examples (although note that if you repeat them, you
14718 will most likely get different file names):
14723 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
14730 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
14732 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
14734 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
14739 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
14740 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
14741 Note that @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, but can create a
14742 secure directory in which the fifo can live. Exit the shell if the
14743 directory or fifo could not be created.
14745 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
14747 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
14751 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
14752 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
14753 or else in @file{/tmp}.
14755 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
14756 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
14757 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
14758 > echo ... > "$file"
14764 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
14765 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
14766 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
14776 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14783 @opindex --directory
14784 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
14785 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
14786 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
14787 umask is more restrictive.
14793 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
14794 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
14800 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
14801 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
14802 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
14803 time between generating the name and using it where another process
14804 can create an object by the same name.
14807 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
14810 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
14811 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
14812 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
14813 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
14814 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
14815 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
14816 directories must already exist.
14818 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
14820 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
14821 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
14822 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
14823 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
14824 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
14825 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
14830 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
14831 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
14832 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
14833 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
14834 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
14835 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
14840 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
14844 0 if the file was created,
14849 @node realpath invocation
14850 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
14853 @cindex file names, canonicalization
14854 @cindex symlinks, resolution
14855 @cindex canonical file name
14856 @cindex canonicalize a file name
14860 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
14861 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
14862 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
14865 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
14868 The file name canonicalization functionality overlaps with that of the
14869 @command{readlink} command. This is the preferred command for
14870 canonicalization as it's a more suitable and standard name. In addition
14871 this command supports relative file name processing functionality.
14873 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14878 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
14880 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
14881 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
14882 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
14883 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
14884 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
14888 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
14890 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
14891 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
14892 treat it as a directory.
14898 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
14899 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
14904 @opindex --physical
14905 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
14906 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
14907 This is the default mode of operation.
14913 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
14915 @item --relative-to=@var{dir}
14916 @opindex --relative-to
14918 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified directory.
14919 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
14920 pertaining to file existence.
14922 @item --relative-base=@var{dir}
14923 @opindex --relative-base
14924 Print the resolved file names as relative @emph{if} the files
14925 are descendants of @var{dir}.
14926 Otherwise, print the resolved file names as absolute.
14927 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
14928 pertaining to file existence.
14929 For details about combining @option{--relative-to} and @option{--relative-base},
14930 @pxref{Realpath usage examples}.
14934 @itemx --no-symlinks
14937 @opindex --no-symlinks
14938 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
14939 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
14940 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
14941 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
14947 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
14951 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
14956 * Realpath usage examples:: Realpath usage examples.
14960 @node Realpath usage examples
14961 @subsection Realpath usage examples
14963 @opindex --relative-to
14964 @opindex --relative-base
14966 By default, @command{realpath} prints the absolute file name of given files
14967 (symlinks are resolved, @file{words} is resolved to @file{american-english}):
14972 realpath /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14973 @result{} /usr/bin/sort
14975 @result{} /usr/share/dict/american-english
14976 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
14980 With @option{--relative-to}, file names are printed relative to
14981 the given directory:
14985 realpath --relative-to=/usr/bin \
14986 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14988 @result{} ../../tmp/foo
14989 @result{} ../share/dict/american-english
14990 @result{} ../../home/user/1.txt
14994 With @option{--relative-base}, relative file names are printed @emph{if}
14995 the resolved file name is below the given base directory. For files outside the
14996 base directory absolute file names are printed:
15000 realpath --relative-base=/usr \
15001 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
15004 @result{} share/dict/american-english
15005 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
15009 When both @option{--relative-to=DIR1} and @option{--relative-base=DIR2}
15010 are used, file names are printed relative to @var{dir1} @emph{if} they are
15011 located below @var{dir2}. If the files are not below @var{dir2}, they are
15012 printed as absolute file names:
15016 realpath --relative-to=/usr/bin --relative-base=/usr \
15017 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
15020 @result{} ../share/dict/american-english
15021 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
15025 When both @option{--relative-to=DIR1} and @option{--relative-base=DIR2}
15026 are used, @var{dir1} @emph{must} be a subdirectory of @var{dir2}. Otherwise,
15027 @command{realpath} prints absolutes file names.
15030 @node Working context
15031 @chapter Working context
15033 @cindex working context
15034 @cindex commands for printing the working context
15036 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
15037 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
15038 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
15041 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
15042 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
15043 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
15044 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
15048 @node pwd invocation
15049 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
15052 @cindex print name of current directory
15053 @cindex current working directory, printing
15054 @cindex working directory, printing
15057 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
15060 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
15063 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15070 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
15071 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
15072 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
15073 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
15078 @opindex --physical
15079 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
15080 components of the printed name will be actual directory names -- none
15081 will be symbolic links.
15084 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
15085 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
15086 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
15087 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
15088 environment variable is set.
15090 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
15095 @node stty invocation
15096 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
15099 @cindex change or print terminal settings
15100 @cindex terminal settings
15101 @cindex line settings of terminal
15103 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
15107 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
15108 stty [@var{option}]
15111 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
15112 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
15113 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
15114 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
15115 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
15116 @option{--file} option.
15118 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
15119 the terminal line operation, as described below.
15121 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15128 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
15129 be used in combination with any line settings.
15131 @item -F @var{device}
15132 @itemx --file=@var{device}
15135 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
15136 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
15137 because opening a POSIX tty requires use of the
15138 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a POSIX tty from blocking
15139 until the carrier detect line is high if
15140 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
15141 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
15147 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
15148 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
15149 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
15150 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
15154 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
15155 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
15156 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
15157 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
15160 Some settings are not available on all POSIX systems, since they use
15161 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
15162 ``Non-POSIX'' in their description. On non-POSIX
15163 systems, those or other settings also may not
15164 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
15167 @command{stty} is installed only on platforms with the POSIX terminal
15168 interface, so portable scripts should not rely on its existence on
15169 non-POSIX platforms.
15174 * Control:: Control settings
15175 * Input:: Input settings
15176 * Output:: Output settings
15177 * Local:: Local settings
15178 * Combination:: Combination settings
15179 * Characters:: Special characters
15180 * Special:: Special settings
15185 @subsection Control settings
15187 @cindex control settings
15193 @cindex two-way parity
15194 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
15200 @cindex even parity
15201 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
15205 @cindex constant parity
15206 @cindex stick parity
15207 @cindex mark parity
15208 @cindex space parity
15209 Use "stick" (mark/space) parity. If parodd is set, the parity bit is
15210 always 1; if parodd is not set, the parity bit is always zero.
15211 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15218 @cindex character size
15219 @cindex eight-bit characters
15220 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
15225 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
15231 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
15235 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
15239 @cindex modem control
15240 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
15244 @cindex hardware flow control
15245 @cindex flow control, hardware
15246 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
15247 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15251 @cindex hardware flow control
15252 @cindex flow control, hardware
15253 @cindex DTR/DSR flow control
15254 Enable DTR/DSR flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15259 @subsection Input settings
15261 @cindex input settings
15262 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
15267 @cindex breaks, ignoring
15268 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
15272 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
15273 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
15277 @cindex parity, ignoring
15278 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
15282 @cindex parity errors, marking
15283 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
15287 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
15291 @cindex eight-bit input
15292 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
15296 @cindex newline, translating to return
15297 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
15301 @cindex return, ignoring
15302 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
15306 @cindex return, translating to newline
15307 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
15311 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
15312 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
15316 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
15317 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
15318 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{Ctrl-S}/@kbd{Ctrl-Q}). May
15325 @cindex software flow control
15326 @cindex flow control, software
15327 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
15328 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
15329 empty again. May be negated.
15333 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
15334 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
15335 negated. Note ilcuc is not implemented, as one would not be able to issue
15336 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
15340 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
15341 if negated). Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15345 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
15346 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
15347 when the input buffer is full. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15352 @subsection Output settings
15354 @cindex output settings
15355 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
15360 Postprocess output. May be negated.
15364 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
15365 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
15366 negated. (Note ouclc is not currently implemented.)
15370 @cindex return, translating to newline
15371 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15375 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
15376 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-POSIX@. May be
15381 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-POSIX@.
15386 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15390 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
15391 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
15397 @cindex pad character
15398 Use ASCII DEL characters for fill instead of
15399 ASCII NUL characters. Non-POSIX@.
15405 Newline delay style. Non-POSIX.
15412 Carriage return delay style. Non-POSIX.
15418 @opindex tab@var{n}
15419 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
15424 Backspace delay style. Non-POSIX.
15429 Vertical tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
15434 Form feed delay style. Non-POSIX.
15439 @subsection Local settings
15441 @cindex local settings
15446 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
15447 characters. May be negated.
15451 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
15452 special characters. May be negated.
15456 Enable non-POSIX special characters. May be negated.
15460 Echo input characters. May be negated.
15466 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
15471 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
15472 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
15476 @cindex newline, echoing
15477 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
15481 @cindex flushing, disabling
15482 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
15483 characters. May be negated.
15487 @cindex case translation
15488 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
15489 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
15490 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15494 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
15495 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-POSIX@.
15502 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
15503 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15509 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
15510 @cindex hat notation for control characters
15511 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
15512 of literally. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15518 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
15519 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
15520 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
15526 Enable @samp{LINEMODE}, which is used to avoid echoing
15527 each character over high latency links. See also
15528 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc1116/, Internet RFC 1116}.
15535 Note this setting is currently ignored on GNU/Linux systems.
15542 @subsection Combination settings
15544 @cindex combination settings
15545 Combination settings:
15552 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
15553 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
15557 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
15558 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
15562 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
15563 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
15567 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
15574 @c This is too long to write inline.
15576 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl
15577 icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl -noflsh
15578 -ixoff -iutf8 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel -xcase -olcuc -ocrnl
15579 opost -ofill onlcr -onocr -onlret nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0 ff0
15580 isig -tostop -ofdel -echoprt echoctl echoke -extproc
15584 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
15588 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
15589 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
15590 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
15591 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
15598 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
15599 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -icanon -opost
15600 -isig -iuclc -ixany -imaxbel -xcase min 1 time 0
15604 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
15608 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
15613 @cindex eight-bit characters
15614 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
15615 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
15619 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
15620 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
15624 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15628 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated. If negated, same
15635 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15636 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
15640 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
15644 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
15649 @subsection Special characters
15651 @cindex special characters
15652 @cindex characters, special
15654 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
15655 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
15656 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
15657 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
15658 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
15659 any other digit to indicate decimal.
15661 @cindex disabling special characters
15662 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
15663 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
15664 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
15665 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
15666 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
15667 special character to @key{U}.)
15673 Send an interrupt signal.
15677 Send a quit signal.
15681 Erase the last character typed.
15685 Erase the current line.
15689 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
15697 Alternate character to end the line. Non-POSIX.
15702 Alternate character to toggle discarding of output. Non-POSIX.
15706 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-POSIX.
15710 Send an info signal. Not currently supported on GNU/Linux. Non-POSIX.
15714 Restart the output after stopping it.
15722 Send a terminal stop signal.
15726 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-POSIX.
15730 Redraw the current line. Non-POSIX.
15734 Erase the last word typed. Non-POSIX.
15738 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
15739 character. Non-POSIX.
15744 @subsection Special settings
15746 @cindex special settings
15751 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
15752 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
15756 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
15757 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
15759 @item ispeed @var{n}
15761 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
15763 @item ospeed @var{n}
15765 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
15769 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
15773 @itemx columns @var{n}
15776 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-POSIX.
15780 @cindex nonblocking @command{stty} setting
15781 Apply settings after first waiting for pending output to be transmitted.
15782 This is enabled by default for GNU @command{stty}.
15783 Note this is treated as an option rather than a line setting,
15784 and will follow the option processing rules described in the summary above.
15785 It is useful to disable this option
15786 in cases where the system may be in a state where serial transmission
15788 For example, if the system has received the @samp{DC3} character
15789 with @code{ixon} (software flow control) enabled, then @command{stty} would
15790 block without @code{-drain} being specified.
15791 May be negated. Non-POSIX.
15797 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
15798 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
15799 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
15800 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
15805 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-POSIX.
15809 Print the terminal speed.
15812 @cindex baud rate, setting
15813 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
15814 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
15815 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
15816 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
15817 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
15834 4000000 where the system supports these.
15835 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
15839 @node printenv invocation
15840 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
15843 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
15844 @cindex environment variables, printing
15846 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
15849 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
15852 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
15853 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
15854 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
15856 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15864 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
15868 0 if all variables specified were found
15869 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
15870 2 if a write error occurred
15874 @node tty invocation
15875 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
15878 @cindex print terminal file name
15879 @cindex terminal file name, printing
15881 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
15882 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
15886 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
15889 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15899 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
15903 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
15907 0 if standard input is a terminal
15908 1 if standard input is a non-terminal file
15909 2 if given incorrect arguments
15910 3 if a write error occurs
15914 @node User information
15915 @chapter User information
15917 @cindex user information, commands for
15918 @cindex commands for printing user information
15920 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
15921 logins, groups, and so forth.
15924 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
15925 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
15926 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
15927 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
15928 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
15929 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
15933 @node id invocation
15934 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
15937 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
15938 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
15939 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
15941 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
15942 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
15945 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user}]@dots{}
15948 @var{user} can be either a user ID or a name, with name look-up
15949 taking precedence unless the ID is specified with a leading @samp{+}.
15950 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
15952 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
15953 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
15954 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
15955 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
15956 In addition, if SELinux
15957 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
15958 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
15960 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
15961 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
15963 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
15964 Also see @ref{Common options}.
15971 Print only the group ID.
15977 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
15983 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
15984 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
15990 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID@. Requires
15991 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
15997 Print only the user ID.
16004 @cindex security context
16005 Print only the security context of the process, which is generally
16006 the user's security context inherited from the parent process.
16007 If neither SELinux or SMACK is enabled then print a warning and
16008 set the exit status to 1.
16014 Delimit output items with ASCII NUL characters.
16015 This option is not permitted when using the default format.
16016 When multiple users are specified, and the @option{--groups} option
16017 is also in effect, groups are delimited with a single NUL character,
16018 while users are delimited with two NUL characters.
16023 users <NUL> devs <NUL>
16028 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
16029 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
16030 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
16031 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
16032 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
16033 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
16034 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
16036 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
16040 @node logname invocation
16041 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
16044 @cindex printing user's login name
16045 @cindex login name, printing
16046 @cindex user name, printing
16049 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
16050 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16051 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
16052 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
16053 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
16055 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16061 @node whoami invocation
16062 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user name
16065 @cindex effective user name, printing
16066 @cindex printing the effective user ID
16068 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
16069 effective user ID@. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
16071 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16077 @node groups invocation
16078 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
16081 @cindex printing groups a user is in
16082 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
16084 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
16085 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
16086 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
16088 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
16089 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
16092 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
16095 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
16097 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16100 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
16104 @node users invocation
16105 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
16108 @cindex printing current usernames
16109 @cindex usernames, printing current
16111 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
16112 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
16113 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
16114 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
16115 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
16124 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
16125 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16126 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
16127 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
16129 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16132 The @command{users} command is installed only on platforms with the
16133 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
16134 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16139 @node who invocation
16140 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
16143 @cindex printing current user information
16144 @cindex information, about current users
16146 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
16150 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
16153 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
16155 @cindex remote hostname
16156 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
16157 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
16158 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
16162 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
16163 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16164 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
16165 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
16166 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
16170 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
16171 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
16172 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
16173 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
16176 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
16177 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
16178 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
16179 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
16181 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16189 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
16195 Print the date and time of last system boot.
16201 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
16207 Print a line of column headings.
16213 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
16214 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
16218 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
16219 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
16220 automatic dial-up internet access.
16224 Same as @samp{who am i}.
16230 List active processes spawned by init.
16236 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
16237 Overrides all other options.
16242 @opindex --runlevel
16243 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
16247 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
16253 Print last system clock change.
16258 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
16259 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
16260 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
16271 @opindex --writable
16272 @cindex message status
16273 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
16274 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
16277 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
16278 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
16279 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
16284 The @command{who} command is installed only on platforms with the
16285 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
16286 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16291 @node System context
16292 @chapter System context
16294 @cindex system context
16295 @cindex context, system
16296 @cindex commands for system context
16298 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
16302 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
16303 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
16304 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
16305 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
16306 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
16307 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
16308 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
16311 @node date invocation
16312 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
16315 @cindex time, printing or setting
16316 @cindex printing the current time
16321 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
16322 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
16323 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
16326 The @command{date} command displays the date and time.
16327 With the @option{--set} (@option{-s}) option, or with
16328 @samp{MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss]},
16329 it sets the date and time.
16332 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
16333 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
16334 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
16335 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Jul @ 9 17:00:00 EDT 2020}.
16338 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
16339 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
16340 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
16341 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
16346 * Date format specifiers:: Used in @samp{date '+...'}
16347 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
16348 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
16350 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
16352 * Examples of date:: Examples.
16355 @node Date format specifiers
16356 @subsection Specifying the format of @command{date} output
16358 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
16359 @cindex time formats
16360 @cindex formatting times
16361 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
16362 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
16363 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
16364 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
16365 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
16366 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
16370 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
16371 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
16372 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
16373 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
16376 @node Time conversion specifiers
16377 @subsubsection Time conversion specifiers
16379 @cindex time conversion specifiers
16380 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
16382 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
16386 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
16388 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
16390 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}@.
16391 This is a GNU extension.
16393 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}@.
16394 This is a GNU extension.
16396 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
16398 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
16399 This is a GNU extension.
16401 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
16402 blank in many locales.
16403 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
16405 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
16406 This is a GNU extension.
16408 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
16410 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
16412 @cindex Epoch, seconds since
16413 @cindex seconds since the Epoch
16414 @cindex beginning of time
16415 @cindex leap seconds
16416 seconds since the Epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC@.
16417 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
16418 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
16419 This is a GNU extension.
16421 @cindex leap seconds
16422 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
16423 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
16425 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
16427 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
16429 Four-digit numeric time zone, e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}, or
16431 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
16432 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
16433 by the @env{TZ} environment variable. A time zone is not determinable if
16434 its numeric offset is zero and its abbreviation begins with @samp{-}.
16435 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
16436 by the @option{--date} option.
16438 Numeric time zone with @samp{:}, e.g., @samp{-06:00} or
16439 @samp{+05:30}), or @samp{-00:00} if no time zone is determinable.
16440 This is a GNU extension.
16442 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
16443 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or @samp{-00:00:00} if no time zone is
16445 This is a GNU extension.
16447 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
16448 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or @samp{-00} if
16449 no time zone is determinable.
16450 This is a GNU extension.
16452 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
16453 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
16457 @node Date conversion specifiers
16458 @subsubsection Date conversion specifiers
16460 @cindex date conversion specifiers
16461 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
16463 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
16467 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
16469 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
16471 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
16473 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
16475 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2020})
16477 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
16478 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2019},
16479 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
16480 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
16482 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
16484 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
16486 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
16488 full date in ISO 8601 format; like @samp{%+4Y-%m-%d}
16489 except that any flags or field width override the @samp{+}
16490 and (after subtracting 6) the @samp{4}.
16491 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
16492 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
16495 year corresponding to the ISO week number, but without the century
16496 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
16497 as @samp{%y}, except that if the ISO week number (see
16499 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
16501 year corresponding to the ISO week number. This has the
16502 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the ISO
16504 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
16506 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
16507 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
16508 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
16512 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
16514 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
16516 quarter of year (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{4})
16518 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
16520 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
16521 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16522 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
16524 ISO week number, that is, the
16525 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
16526 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16527 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
16528 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
16529 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the ISO 8601
16532 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
16534 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
16535 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16536 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
16538 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
16540 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
16542 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
16543 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
16544 precedes year @samp{0000}.
16548 @node Literal conversion specifiers
16549 @subsubsection Literal conversion specifiers
16551 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
16552 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
16554 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
16566 @node Padding and other flags
16567 @subsubsection Padding and other flags
16569 @cindex numeric field padding
16570 @cindex padding of numeric fields
16571 @cindex fields, padding numeric
16573 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
16574 with zeros, so that, for
16575 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
16576 Most numeric fields are padded on the left.
16577 However, nanoseconds are padded on the right since they are commonly
16578 used after decimal points in formats like @samp{%s.%-N}.
16579 Also, seconds since the Epoch are not padded
16580 since there is no natural width for them.
16582 The following optional flags can appear after the @samp{%}:
16586 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
16588 This is a GNU extension.
16589 As a special case, @samp{%-N} outputs only enough trailing digits to
16590 not lose information, assuming that the timestamp's resolution is the
16591 same as the current hardware clock. For example, if the hardware
16592 clock resolution is 1 microsecond, @samp{%s.%-N} outputs something
16593 like @samp{1640890100.395710}.
16596 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
16597 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
16598 This is a GNU extension.
16600 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
16601 would normally pad with spaces.
16603 Pad with zeros, like @samp{0}. In addition, precede any year number
16604 with @samp{+} if it exceeds 9999 or if its field width exceeds 4;
16605 similarly, precede any century number with @samp{+} if it exceeds 99
16606 or if its field width exceeds 2. This supports ISO 8601 formats
16607 for dates far in the future; for example, the command @code{date
16608 --date=12019-02-25 +%+13F} outputs the string @samp{+012019-02-25}.
16610 Use upper case characters if possible.
16611 This is a GNU extension.
16613 Use opposite case characters if possible.
16614 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
16615 This is a GNU extension.
16619 Here are some examples of padding:
16622 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
16624 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
16626 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
16630 You can optionally specify the field width
16631 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
16632 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
16633 the result is normally written right adjusted and padded to the given
16634 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
16635 a field of width 9. Nanoseconds are left adjusted, and are truncated
16636 or padded to the field width.
16638 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
16639 specification. The modifiers are:
16643 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
16644 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
16645 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
16646 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
16650 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
16651 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
16654 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
16655 is available, it is ignored.
16657 POSIX specifies the behavior of flags and field widths only for
16658 @samp{%C}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}, and @samp{%Y} (all without
16659 modifiers), and requires a flag to be present if and only if a field
16660 width is also present. Other combinations of flags, field widths and
16661 modifiers are GNU extensions.
16664 @node Setting the time
16665 @subsection Setting the time
16667 @cindex setting the time
16668 @cindex time setting
16669 @cindex appropriate privileges
16671 You must have appropriate privileges to set the
16672 system clock. For changes to persist across a reboot, the
16673 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
16674 might not happen automatically on your system.
16676 To set the clock, you can use the @option{--set} (@option{-s}) option
16677 (@pxref{Options for date}). To set the clock without using GNU
16678 extensions, you can give @command{date} an argument of the form
16679 @samp{MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss]} where each two-letter
16680 component stands for two digits with the following meanings:
16692 first two digits of year (optional)
16694 last two digits of year (optional)
16699 Note, the @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
16700 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
16701 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
16702 relative to Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
16705 @node Options for date
16706 @subsection Options for @command{date}
16708 @cindex @command{date} options
16709 @cindex options for @command{date}
16711 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16712 Except for @option{-u}, these options are all GNU extensions to POSIX.
16714 All options that specify the date to display are mutually exclusive.
16715 I.e.: @option{--date}, @option{--file}, @option{--reference},
16716 @option{--resolution}.
16720 @item -d @var{datestr}
16721 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
16724 @cindex parsing date strings
16725 @cindex date strings, parsing
16726 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
16729 @opindex next @var{day}
16730 @opindex last @var{day}
16731 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
16732 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
16733 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
16734 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2020-07-21
16735 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
16736 489,392,193 nanoseconds after July 21, 2020 at 2:19:13 PM in a
16737 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of UTC.@*
16738 Note: input currently must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
16739 LC_TIME=C below is needed to print back the correct date in many locales:
16741 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
16743 @xref{Date input formats}.
16747 @cindex debugging date strings
16748 @cindex date strings, debugging
16749 @cindex arbitrary date strings, debugging
16750 Annotate the parsed date, display the effective time zone, and warn about
16753 @item -f @var{datefile}
16754 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
16757 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
16758 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
16759 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
16760 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
16763 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
16764 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
16765 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
16766 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
16767 Display the date using an ISO 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
16769 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
16770 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
16773 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
16774 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
16777 Also print hours and time zone.
16778 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H%:z}.
16781 Also print minutes.
16782 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M%:z}.
16785 Also print seconds.
16786 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M:%S%:z}.
16789 Also print nanoseconds.
16790 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M:%S,%N%:z}.
16793 @macro dateParseNote
16794 This format is always suitable as input
16795 for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
16796 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
16800 @item -r @var{file}
16801 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
16803 @opindex --reference
16804 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
16805 instead of the current date and time.
16808 @opindex --resolution
16809 Display the timestamp resolution instead of the time.
16810 Current clock timestamps that are output by @command{date}
16811 are integer multiples of the timestamp resolution.
16812 With this option, the format defaults to @samp{%s.%N}.
16813 For example, if the clock resolution is 1 millisecond,
16823 @opindex --rfc-email
16824 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
16825 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
16829 Mon, 09 Jul 2020 17:00:00 -0400
16833 @opindex --rfc-2822
16834 This format conforms to Internet RFCs
16835 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc5322/, 5322},
16836 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc2822/, 2822} and
16837 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc822/, 822}, the
16838 current and previous standards for Internet email.
16839 For compatibility with older versions of @command{date},
16840 @option{--rfc-2822} and @option{--rfc-822} are aliases for
16841 @option{--rfc-email}.
16843 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
16844 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
16845 Display the date using a format specified by
16846 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc3339/, Internet
16847 RFC 3339}. This is like @option{--iso-8601}, except that a space rather
16848 than a @samp{T} separates dates from times, and a period rather than
16849 a comma separates seconds from subseconds.
16852 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
16853 It can be one of the following:
16857 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21}.
16858 This is like the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
16861 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
16862 @samp{2020-07-21 04:30:37+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
16863 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
16864 hours and thirty minutes east of UTC@. This is like
16865 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
16868 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
16869 @samp{2020-07-21 04:30:37.998458565+05:30}.
16870 This is like the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
16874 @item -s @var{datestr}
16875 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
16878 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
16879 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
16886 @opindex --universal
16887 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
16889 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
16891 @cindex leap seconds
16893 @cindex Universal Time
16894 Use Universal Time by operating as if the
16895 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
16896 UTC stands for Coordinated Universal Time, established in 1960.
16897 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (GMT) for
16898 historical reasons.
16899 Typically, systems ignore leap seconds and thus implement an
16900 approximation to UTC rather than true UTC.
16904 @node Examples of date
16905 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
16907 @cindex examples of @command{date}
16909 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
16910 option in the previous section.
16915 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
16918 date --date='2 days ago'
16922 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
16925 date --date='3 months 1 day'
16929 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
16932 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
16936 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
16942 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
16943 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
16944 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
16947 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
16948 of the month, you can use the (GNU extension)
16949 @samp{-} flag to suppress
16950 the padding altogether:
16953 date -d 1may '+%B %-d'
16957 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
16958 non-GNU versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
16961 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
16965 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
16968 date --set='+2 minutes'
16972 To print the date in Internet RFC 5322 format,
16973 use @samp{date --rfc-email}. Here is some example output:
16976 Tue, 09 Jul 2020 19:00:37 -0400
16979 @anchor{%s-examples}
16981 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the Epoch
16982 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
16983 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
16984 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
16985 number of the seconds since the Epoch for the time two minutes after the
16989 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
16993 To convert a date string from one time zone @var{from} to another @var{to},
16994 specify @samp{TZ="@var{from}"} in the environment and @samp{TZ="@var{to}"}
16995 in the @option{--date} option. @xref{Specifying time zone rules}.
16999 TZ="Asia/Tokyo" date --date='TZ="America/New_York" 2023-05-07 12:23'
17000 Mon May @ 8 01:23:00 JST 2023
17003 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
17004 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
17005 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
17006 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
17007 seconds) behind UTC:
17010 # local time zone used
17011 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
17016 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
17017 represented as seconds since the Epoch. But few people can look at
17018 the date @samp{1577836800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first
17019 second of the year 2020 in Greenwich, England.''
17022 date --date='2020-01-01 UTC' +%s
17026 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
17027 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
17028 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
17029 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
17030 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
17033 date -u --date=2020-07-21 +%s
17037 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
17038 a more readable form, use a command like this:
17041 date -d @@1595289600 +"%F %T %z"
17042 2020-07-20 20:00:00 -0400
17045 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
17048 date -u -d @@1595289600 +"%F %T %z"
17049 2020-07-21 00:00:00 +0000
17053 @cindex leap seconds
17054 Typically the seconds count omits leap seconds, but some systems are
17055 exceptions. Because leap seconds are not predictable, the mapping
17056 between the seconds count and a future timestamp is not reliable on
17057 the atypical systems that include leap seconds in their counts.
17059 Here is how the two kinds of systems handle the leap second at
17060 the end of the year 2016:
17063 # Typical systems ignore leap seconds:
17064 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
17066 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
17067 date: invalid date '2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000'
17068 date --date='2017-01-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
17073 # Atypical systems count leap seconds:
17074 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
17076 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
17078 date --date='2017-01-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
17085 @node arch invocation
17086 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
17089 @cindex print machine hardware name
17090 @cindex system information, printing
17092 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
17093 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
17097 arch [@var{option}]
17100 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
17102 @command{arch} is not installed by default, so portable scripts should
17103 not rely on its existence.
17108 @node nproc invocation
17109 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
17112 @cindex Print the number of processors
17113 @cindex system information, printing
17115 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
17116 which may be less than the number of online processors.
17117 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
17118 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} or @env{OMP_THREAD_LIMIT}
17119 environment variables are set, then they will determine the minimum
17120 and maximum returned value respectively. The result is guaranteed to be
17121 greater than zero. Synopsis:
17124 nproc [@var{option}]
17127 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17133 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
17134 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
17135 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} or @env{OMP_THREAD_LIMIT} environment variables
17136 are not honored in this case.
17138 @item --ignore=@var{number}
17140 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
17147 @node uname invocation
17148 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
17151 @cindex print system information
17152 @cindex system information, printing
17154 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
17155 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
17156 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
17159 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
17162 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
17163 printed in this order:
17166 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
17167 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
17170 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
17171 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{kernel-version} is
17172 @samp{#1 SMP Fri Jul 17 17:18:38 UTC 2020}:
17176 @result{} Linux dumdum.example.org 5.9.16-200.fc33.x86_64@c
17177 #1 SMP Mon Dec 21 14:08:22 UTC 2020 x86_64 x86_64 x86_64 GNU/Linux
17181 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17189 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
17190 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
17193 @itemx --hardware-platform
17195 @opindex --hardware-platform
17196 @cindex implementation, hardware
17197 @cindex hardware platform
17198 @cindex platform, hardware
17199 Print the hardware platform name
17200 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
17201 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
17202 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
17208 @cindex machine type
17209 @cindex hardware class
17210 @cindex hardware type
17211 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
17217 @opindex --nodename
17220 @cindex network node name
17221 Print the network node hostname.
17226 @opindex --processor
17227 @cindex host processor type
17228 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
17229 architecture or ISA).
17230 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
17231 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
17234 @itemx --operating-system
17236 @opindex --operating-system
17237 @cindex operating system name
17238 Print the name of the operating system.
17241 @itemx --kernel-release
17243 @opindex --kernel-release
17244 @cindex kernel release
17245 @cindex release of kernel
17246 Print the kernel release.
17249 @itemx --kernel-name
17251 @opindex --kernel-name
17252 @cindex kernel name
17253 @cindex name of kernel
17254 Print the kernel name.
17255 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
17256 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
17257 POSIX specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
17258 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
17259 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
17260 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
17261 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
17265 @itemx --kernel-version
17267 @opindex --kernel-version
17268 @cindex kernel version
17269 @cindex version of kernel
17270 Print the kernel version.
17277 @node hostname invocation
17278 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
17281 @cindex setting the hostname
17282 @cindex printing the hostname
17283 @cindex system name, printing
17284 @cindex appropriate privileges
17286 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
17287 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
17288 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
17292 hostname [@var{name}]
17295 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
17298 @command{hostname} is not installed by default, and other packages
17299 also supply a @command{hostname} command, so portable scripts should
17300 not rely on its existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
17305 @node hostid invocation
17306 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
17309 @cindex printing the host identifier
17311 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
17312 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
17313 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
17314 @xref{Common options}.
17316 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
17323 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
17324 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
17327 @command{hostid} is installed only on systems that have the
17328 @code{gethostid} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17333 @node uptime invocation
17334 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
17337 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
17339 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
17340 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
17342 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
17343 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
17344 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
17345 the default setting).
17347 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
17348 @xref{Common options}.
17350 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
17354 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
17357 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
17358 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
17359 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
17360 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
17361 those processes which are waiting for device I/O). The Linux kernel
17362 includes uninterruptible processes.
17364 @command{uptime} is installed only on platforms with infrastructure
17365 for obtaining the boot time, and other packages also supply an
17366 @command{uptime} command, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17367 existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
17371 @node SELinux context
17372 @chapter SELinux context
17374 @cindex SELinux context
17375 @cindex SELinux, context
17376 @cindex commands for SELinux context
17378 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
17382 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
17383 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
17386 @node chcon invocation
17387 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
17390 @cindex changing security context
17391 @cindex change SELinux context
17393 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
17397 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
17398 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
17399 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
17400 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
17403 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
17404 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
17405 to that of @var{rfile}.
17407 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17411 @item --dereference
17412 @opindex --dereference
17413 Do not affect symbolic links but what they refer to; this is the default.
17416 @itemx --no-dereference
17418 @opindex --no-dereference
17419 @cindex no dereference
17420 Affect the symbolic links themselves instead of any referenced file.
17422 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
17423 @opindex --reference
17424 @cindex reference file
17425 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
17430 @opindex --recursive
17431 Operate on files and directories recursively.
17433 @item --preserve-root
17434 @opindex --preserve-root
17435 Refuse to operate recursively on the root directory, @file{/},
17436 when used together with the @option{--recursive} option.
17437 @xref{Treating / specially}.
17439 @item --no-preserve-root
17440 @opindex --no-preserve-root
17441 Do not treat the root directory, @file{/}, specially when operating
17442 recursively; this is the default.
17443 @xref{Treating / specially}.
17446 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17449 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17452 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17459 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
17461 @item -u @var{user}
17462 @itemx --user=@var{user}
17465 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
17467 @item -r @var{role}
17468 @itemx --role=@var{role}
17471 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
17473 @item -t @var{type}
17474 @itemx --type=@var{type}
17477 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
17479 @item -l @var{range}
17480 @itemx --range=@var{range}
17483 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
17489 @node runcon invocation
17490 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
17493 @cindex run with security context
17496 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
17500 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
17501 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
17502 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
17505 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
17506 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
17507 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
17509 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
17510 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
17511 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
17512 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
17514 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
17517 @cindex restricted security context
17518 @cindex NO_NEW_PRIVS
17519 Note also the @command{setpriv} command which can be used to set the
17520 NO_NEW_PRIVS bit using @command{setpriv --no-new-privs runcon ...},
17521 thus disallowing usage of a security context with more privileges
17522 than the process would normally have.
17524 @command{runcon} accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17532 Compute process transition context before modifying.
17534 @item -u @var{user}
17535 @itemx --user=@var{user}
17538 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
17540 @item -r @var{role}
17541 @itemx --role=@var{role}
17544 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
17546 @item -t @var{type}
17547 @itemx --type=@var{type}
17550 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
17552 @item -l @var{range}
17553 @itemx --range=@var{range}
17556 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
17560 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
17564 125 if @command{runcon} itself fails
17565 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17566 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17567 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17570 @node Modified command invocation
17571 @chapter Modified command invocation
17573 @cindex modified command invocation
17574 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
17575 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
17577 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
17578 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
17582 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
17583 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
17584 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
17585 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
17586 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
17587 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
17591 @node chroot invocation
17592 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
17595 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
17596 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
17598 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
17599 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
17600 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
17601 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
17602 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
17603 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.
17604 Furthermore, the @command{chroot} command avoids the @code{chroot} system call
17605 when @var{newroot} is identical to the old @file{/} directory for consistency
17606 with systems where this is allowed for non-privileged users.}.
17610 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
17611 chroot @var{option}
17614 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
17615 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
17616 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist), then changes the working
17617 directory to @file{/}, and finally runs @var{command} with optional @var{args}.
17618 If @var{command} is not specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL}
17619 environment variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the
17620 @option{-i} option.
17621 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
17622 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
17624 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17625 Options must precede operands.
17629 @item --groups=@var{groups}
17631 Use this option to override the supplementary @var{groups} to be
17632 used by the new process.
17633 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
17634 Use @samp{--groups=''} to disable the supplementary group look-up
17635 implicit in the @option{--userspec} option.
17637 @item --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
17638 @opindex --userspec
17639 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
17640 as the invoking process.
17641 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
17642 different primary @var{group}.
17643 If a @var{user} is specified then the supplementary groups
17644 are set according to the system defined list for that user,
17645 unless overridden with the @option{--groups} option.
17648 @opindex --skip-chdir
17649 Use this option to not change the working directory to @file{/} after changing
17650 the root directory to @var{newroot}, i.e., inside the chroot.
17651 This option is only permitted when @var{newroot} is the old @file{/} directory,
17652 and therefore is mostly useful together with the @option{--groups} and
17653 @option{--userspec} options to retain the previous working directory.
17657 The user and group name look-up performed by the @option{--userspec}
17658 and @option{--groups} options, is done both outside and inside
17659 the chroot, with successful look-ups inside the chroot taking precedence.
17660 If the specified user or group items are intended to represent a numeric ID,
17661 then a name to ID resolving step is avoided by specifying a leading @samp{+}.
17662 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
17664 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
17665 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
17666 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
17667 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
17668 your new root directory.
17670 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
17671 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
17674 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
17677 Then you'll see output like this:
17682 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
17685 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
17686 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
17687 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
17688 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
17689 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
17690 device files), copy them into place, too.
17692 @command{chroot} is installed only on systems that have the
17693 @code{chroot} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17696 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
17700 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
17701 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17702 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17703 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17707 @node env invocation
17708 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
17711 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
17712 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
17713 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
17715 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
17718 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17719 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
17720 env -[v]S'[@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17721 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]'
17725 @command{env} is commonly used on first line of scripts (shebang line):
17727 #!/usr/bin/env @var{command}
17728 #!/usr/bin/env -[v]S[@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17729 @var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}
17732 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
17733 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
17734 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
17735 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
17736 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
17737 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
17739 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
17740 characters other than @samp{=} and ASCII NUL.
17741 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
17742 consist solely of underscores, digits, and ASCII letters,
17743 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
17744 work well with other names.
17747 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
17748 specifies the program to invoke; it is
17749 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
17750 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
17751 The program should not be a special built-in utility
17752 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
17754 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
17755 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
17756 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
17757 such as @file{/bin}.
17759 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
17760 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
17761 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
17762 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
17763 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
17766 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
17767 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
17768 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
17769 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
17770 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
17773 @cindex environment, printing
17775 If no command name is specified following the environment
17776 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
17777 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
17779 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
17780 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
17781 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
17786 Output the current environment.
17788 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
17791 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
17795 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
17796 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
17798 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
17802 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
17803 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
17804 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
17811 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
17812 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
17813 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
17815 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
17819 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
17820 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
17821 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
17822 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
17824 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
17830 @subsection General options
17832 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17833 Options must precede operands.
17839 @item -u @var{name}
17840 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
17843 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
17848 @itemx --ignore-environment
17851 @opindex --ignore-environment
17852 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
17855 @itemx --chdir=@var{dir}
17858 Change the working directory to @var{dir} before invoking @var{command}.
17859 This differs from the shell built-in @command{cd} in that it starts
17860 @var{command} as a subprocess rather than altering the shell's own working
17861 directory; this allows it to be chained with other commands that run commands
17862 in a different context. For example:
17865 # Run 'true' with /chroot as its root directory and /srv as its working
17867 chroot /chroot env --chdir=/srv true
17868 # Run 'true' with /build as its working directory, FOO=bar in its
17869 # environment, and a time limit of five seconds.
17870 env --chdir=/build FOO=bar timeout 5 true
17873 @item --default-signal[=@var{sig}]
17874 Unblock and reset signal @var{sig} to its default signal handler.
17875 Without @var{sig} all known signals are unblocked and reset to their defaults.
17876 Multiple signals can be comma-separated. An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op.
17877 The following command runs @command{seq} with SIGINT and SIGPIPE set to their
17878 default (which is to terminate the program):
17881 env --default-signal=PIPE,INT seq 1000 | head -n1
17884 In the following example, we see how this is not
17885 possible to do with traditional shells.
17886 Here the first trap command sets SIGPIPE to ignore.
17887 The second trap command ostensibly sets it back to its default,
17888 but POSIX mandates that the shell must not change inherited
17889 state of the signal -- so it is a no-op.
17892 trap '' PIPE && sh -c 'trap - PIPE ; seq inf | head -n1'
17895 Using @option{--default-signal=PIPE} we can
17896 ensure the signal handling is set to its default behavior:
17899 trap '' PIPE && sh -c 'env --default-signal=PIPE seq inf | head -n1'
17903 @item --ignore-signal[=@var{sig}]
17904 Ignore signal @var{sig} when running a program. Without @var{sig} all
17905 known signals are set to ignore. Multiple signals can be comma-separated.
17906 An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op. The following command runs @command{seq}
17907 with SIGINT set to be ignored -- pressing @kbd{Ctrl-C} will not terminate it:
17910 env --ignore-signal=INT seq inf > /dev/null
17913 @samp{SIGCHLD} is special, in that @option{--ignore-signal=CHLD} might have
17914 no effect (POSIX says it's unspecified).
17916 Most operating systems do not allow ignoring @samp{SIGKILL}, @samp{SIGSTOP}
17917 (and possibly other signals). Attempting to ignore these signals will fail.
17919 Multiple (and contradictory) @option{--default-signal=SIG} and
17920 @option{--ignore-signal=SIG} options are processed left-to-right,
17921 with the latter taking precedence. In the following example, @samp{SIGPIPE} is
17922 set to default while @samp{SIGINT} is ignored:
17925 env --default-signal=INT,PIPE --ignore-signal=INT
17928 @item --block-signal[=@var{sig}]
17929 Block signal(s) @var{sig} from being delivered. Without @var{sig} all
17930 known signals are set to blocked. Multiple signals can be comma-separated.
17931 An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op.
17933 @item --list-signal-handling
17934 List blocked or ignored signals to standard error, before executing a command.
17940 Show verbose information for each processing step.
17943 $ env -v -uTERM A=B uname -s
17952 When combined with @option{-S} it is recommended to list @option{-v}
17953 first, e.g. @command{env -vS'string'}.
17955 @item -S @var{string}
17956 @itemx --split-string=@var{string}
17958 @opindex --split-string
17959 @cindex shebang arguments
17960 @cindex scripts arguments
17961 @cindex env in scripts
17962 process and split @var{string} into separate arguments used to pass
17963 multiple arguments on shebang lines. @command{env} supports FreeBSD's
17964 syntax of several escape sequences and environment variable
17965 expansions. See below for details and examples.
17969 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
17973 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
17974 125 if @command{env} itself fails
17975 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17976 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17977 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17980 @subsection @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} usage in scripts
17982 The @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} option enables use of multiple
17983 arguments on the first line of scripts (the shebang line, @samp{#!}).
17985 When a script's interpreter is in a known location, scripts typically
17986 contain the absolute file name in their first line:
17988 @multitable {Python Script:} {#!/usr/bin/python3}
17989 @item Shell script:
18003 @item Python script:
18012 When a script's interpreter is in a non-standard location
18013 in the @env{PATH} environment variable, it is recommended
18014 to use @command{env} on the first line of the script to
18015 find the executable and run it:
18017 @multitable {Python Script:} {#!/usr/bin/env python3}
18018 @item Shell script:
18021 #!/usr/bin/env bash
18028 #!/usr/bin/env perl
18032 @item Python script:
18035 #!/usr/bin/env python3
18041 Most operating systems (e.g. GNU/Linux, BSDs) treat all text after the
18042 first space as a single argument. When using @command{env} in a script
18043 it is thus not possible to specify multiple arguments.
18045 In the following example:
18047 #!/usr/bin/env perl -T -w
18051 The operating system treats @samp{perl -T -w} as one argument (the
18052 program's name), and executing the script fails with:
18055 /usr/bin/env: 'perl -T -w': No such file or directory
18058 The @option{-S} option instructs @command{env} to split the single string
18059 into multiple arguments. The following example works as expected:
18063 #!/usr/bin/env -S perl -T -w
18066 $ chmod a+x hello.pl
18071 And is equivalent to running @command{perl -T -w hello.pl} on the command line
18074 @unnumberedsubsubsec Testing and troubleshooting
18076 @cindex single quotes, and @command{env -S}
18077 @cindex @command{env -S}, and single quotes
18078 @cindex @option{-S}, env and single quotes
18079 To test @command{env -S} on the command line, use single quotes for the
18080 @option{-S} string to emulate a single parameter. Single quotes are not
18081 needed when using @command{env -S} in a shebang line on the first line of a
18082 script (the operating system already treats it as one argument).
18084 The following command is equivalent to the @file{hello.pl} script above:
18087 $ env -S'perl -T -w' hello.pl
18090 @cindex @command{env -S}, debugging
18091 @cindex debugging, @command{env -S}
18093 To troubleshoot @option{-S} usage add the @option{-v} as the first
18094 argument (before @option{-S}).
18096 Using @option{-vS} on a shebang line in a script:
18099 $ cat hello-debug.pl
18100 #!/usr/bin/env -vS perl -T -w
18103 $ chmod a+x hello-debug.pl
18105 split -S: 'perl -T -w'
18113 arg[3]= './hello-debug.pl'
18117 Using @option{-vS} on the command line prompt (adding single quotes):
18120 $ env -vS'perl -T -w' hello-debug.pl
18121 split -S: 'perl -T -w'
18129 arg[3]= 'hello-debug.pl'
18133 @subsection @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} syntax
18135 @unnumberedsubsubsec Splitting arguments by whitespace
18137 Running @command{env -Sstring} splits the @var{string} into
18138 arguments based on unquoted spaces or tab characters.
18139 (Newlines, carriage returns, vertical tabs and form feeds are treated
18140 like spaces and tabs.)
18142 In the following contrived example the @command{awk} variable
18143 @samp{OFS} will be @code{<space>xyz<space>} as these spaces are inside
18144 double quotes. The other space characters are used as argument separators:
18148 #!/usr/bin/env -S awk -v OFS=" xyz " -f
18149 BEGIN @{print 1,2,3@}
18151 $ chmod a+x one.awk
18156 When using @option{-S} on the command line prompt, remember to add
18157 single quotes around the entire string:
18160 $ env -S'awk -v OFS=" xyz " -f' one.awk
18164 @unnumberedsubsubsec Escape sequences
18166 @command{env} supports several escape sequences. These sequences
18167 are processed when unquoted or inside double quotes (unless otherwise noted).
18168 Single quotes disable escape sequences except @samp{\'} and @samp{\\}.
18170 @multitable @columnfractions .10 .90
18173 @tab Ignore the remaining characters in the string.
18174 Cannot be used inside double quotes.
18177 @tab form-feed character (ASCII 0x0C)
18180 @tab new-line character (ASCII 0x0A)
18183 @tab carriage-return character (ASCII 0x0D)
18186 @tab tab character (ASCII 0x09)
18189 @tab vertical tab character (ASCII 0x0B)
18192 @tab A hash @samp{#} character. Used when a @samp{#} character
18193 is needed as the first character of an argument (see 'comments' section
18197 @tab A dollar-sign character @samp{$}. Unescaped @samp{$} characters
18198 are used to expand environment variables (see 'variables' section below).
18201 @tab Inside double-quotes, replaced with a single space character.
18202 Outside quotes, treated as an argument separator. @samp{\_} can be used
18203 to avoid space characters in a shebang line (see examples below).
18206 @tab A double-quote character.
18209 @tab A single-quote character.
18210 This escape sequence works inside single-quoted strings.
18213 @tab A backslash character.
18214 This escape sequence works inside single-quoted strings.
18218 The following @command{awk} script will use tab character as input and output
18219 field separator (instead of spaces and tabs):
18223 #!/usr/bin/env -S awk -v FS="\t" -v OFS="\t" -f
18227 @unnumberedsubsubsec Comments
18229 The escape sequence @samp{\c} (used outside single/double quotes)
18230 causes @command{env} to ignore the rest of the string.
18232 The @samp{#} character causes @command{env} to ignore the rest of
18233 the string when it appears as the first character of an argument.
18234 Use @samp{\#} to reverse this behavior.
18237 $ env -S'printf %s\n A B C'
18242 $ env -S'printf %s\n A# B C'
18247 $ env -S'printf %s\n A #B C'
18250 $ env -S'printf %s\n A \#B C'
18255 $ env -S'printf %s\n A\cB C'
18259 NOTE: The above examples use single quotes as they are executed
18260 on the command-line.
18264 @unnumberedsubsubsec Environment variable expansion
18266 The pattern @samp{$@{VARNAME@}} is used to substitute a value from
18267 the environment variable. The pattern must include the curly braces
18268 (@samp{@{},@samp{@}}). Without them @command{env} will reject the string.
18269 Special shell variables (such as @samp{$@@}, @samp{$*}, @samp{$$}) are
18272 If the environment variable is empty or not set, the pattern will be replaced
18273 by an empty string. The value of @samp{$@{VARNAME@}} will be that of
18274 the executed @command{env}, before any modifications using
18275 @option{-i}/@option{--ignore-environment}/@option{-u}/@option{--unset} or
18276 setting new values using @samp{VAR=VALUE}.
18278 The following python script prepends @file{/opt/custom/modules} to the python
18279 module search path environment variable (@samp{PYTHONPATH}):
18283 #!/usr/bin/env -S PYTHONPATH=/opt/custom/modules/:$@{PYTHONPATH@} python
18288 The expansion of @samp{$@{PYTHONPATH@}} is performed by @command{env},
18289 not by a shell. If the curly braces are omitted, @command{env} will fail:
18293 #!/usr/bin/env -S PYTHONPATH=/opt/custom/modules/:$PYTHONPATH python
18297 $ chmod a+x custom.py
18299 /usr/bin/env: only $@{VARNAME@} expansion is supported, error at: $PYTHONPATH @c
18303 Environment variable expansion happens before clearing the environment
18304 (with @option{-i}) or unsetting specific variables (with @option{-u}):
18307 $ env -S'-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18311 Use @option{-v} to diagnose the operations step-by-step:
18314 $ env -vS'-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18315 expanding $@{USER@} into 'gordon'
18316 split -S: '-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18321 setenv: OLDUSER=gordon
18329 @node nice invocation
18330 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
18334 @cindex scheduling, affecting
18335 @cindex appropriate privileges
18337 @command{nice} prints a process's @dfn{niceness}, or runs
18338 a command with modified niceness. @dfn{niceness} affects how
18339 favorably the process is scheduled in the system.
18343 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
18346 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
18347 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
18348 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
18350 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
18351 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
18352 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
18353 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
18354 may have a wider range of niceness values; conversely, other systems may
18355 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
18356 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
18357 minimum or maximum supported value.
18359 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
18360 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
18361 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
18362 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
18363 terminology, POSIX defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
18364 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the non-negative difference
18365 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
18366 conforms to POSIX, its documentation and diagnostics use the
18367 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
18369 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18370 built-in utilities}).
18372 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
18374 Note to change the @dfn{niceness} of an existing process,
18375 one needs to use the @command{renice} command.
18377 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18378 Options must precede operands.
18381 @item -n @var{adjustment}
18382 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
18384 @opindex --adjustment
18385 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
18386 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
18387 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
18390 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
18391 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
18392 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
18396 @command{nice} is installed only on systems that have the POSIX
18397 @code{setpriority} function, so portable scripts should not rely on
18398 its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
18400 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
18404 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
18405 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
18406 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18407 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18408 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18411 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
18414 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
18417 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
18418 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
18420 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
18431 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
18432 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
18433 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
18437 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
18441 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
18442 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
18445 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
18449 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
18453 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
18455 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
18460 @node nohup invocation
18461 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
18464 @cindex hangups, immunity to
18465 @cindex immunity to hangups
18466 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
18469 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
18470 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
18474 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18477 If standard input is a terminal, redirect it so that terminal sessions
18478 do not mistakenly consider the terminal to be used by the command.
18479 Make the substitute file descriptor unreadable, so that commands that
18480 mistakenly attempt to read from standard input can report an error.
18481 This redirection is a GNU extension; programs intended to be portable
18482 to non-GNU hosts can use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18483 0>/dev/null} instead.
18486 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
18487 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
18488 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
18489 command is not run.
18490 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
18491 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
18492 regardless of the current umask settings.
18494 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
18495 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
18496 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
18497 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
18498 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
18500 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
18501 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
18505 nohup make > make.log
18508 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
18509 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
18510 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
18511 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
18512 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
18514 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18515 built-in utilities}).
18517 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
18518 options}. Options must precede operands.
18520 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
18524 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
18525 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18526 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18527 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18530 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
18534 @node stdbuf invocation
18535 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
18538 @cindex standard streams, buffering
18539 @cindex line buffered
18541 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
18542 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
18545 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
18548 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
18551 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output (note the
18552 programs @command{dd} and @command{cat} don't do that),
18555 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams (note the
18556 program @command{tee} is not in this category).
18559 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
18562 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18566 @item -i @var{mode}
18567 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
18570 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
18572 @item -o @var{mode}
18573 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
18576 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
18578 @item -e @var{mode}
18579 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
18582 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
18586 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
18591 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
18592 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
18593 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
18594 This option is invalid with standard input.
18597 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
18598 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
18599 amount of data requested is read from input.
18600 Note the difference in function for input and output.
18601 Disabling buffering for input will not influence the responsiveness
18602 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
18603 For example @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error,
18604 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
18607 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
18608 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
18612 @command{stdbuf} is installed only on platforms that use the
18613 Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) and support the
18614 @code{constructor} attribute, so portable scripts should not rely on
18617 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
18621 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
18622 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18623 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18624 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18628 @node timeout invocation
18629 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
18633 @cindex run commands with bounded time
18635 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
18636 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
18639 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18642 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18643 built-in utilities}).
18645 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18646 Options must precede operands.
18649 @item --preserve-status
18650 @opindex --preserve-status
18651 Return the exit status of the managed @var{command} on timeout, rather than
18652 a specific exit status indicating a timeout. This is useful if the
18653 managed @var{command} supports running for an indeterminate amount of time.
18656 @opindex --foreground
18657 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
18658 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
18659 This is needed to support two situations when timing out commands,
18660 when not invoking @command{timeout} from an interactive shell.
18663 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
18665 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
18666 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
18669 Note in this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
18670 will not be timed out. Also SIGCONT will not be sent to @var{command},
18671 as it's generally not needed with foreground processes, and can
18672 cause intermittent signal delivery issues with programs that are monitors
18673 themselves (like GDB for example).
18675 @item -k @var{duration}
18676 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
18678 @opindex --kill-after
18679 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
18682 The specified @var{duration} starts from the point in time when
18683 @command{timeout} sends the initial signal to @var{command}, i.e.,
18684 not from the beginning when the @var{command} is started.
18686 This option has no effect if either the main @var{duration}
18687 of the @command{timeout} command, or the @var{duration} specified
18688 to this option, is 0.
18690 This option may be useful if the selected signal did not kill the @var{command},
18691 either because the signal was blocked or ignored, or if the @var{command} takes
18692 too long (e.g. for cleanup work) to terminate itself within a certain amount
18695 @item -s @var{signal}
18696 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
18699 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
18700 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
18701 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
18707 Diagnose to standard error, any signal sent upon timeout.
18711 @var{duration} is a floating point number in either the current or the
18712 C locale (@pxref{Floating point}) followed by an optional unit:
18714 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
18715 @samp{m} for minutes
18719 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
18720 Note that the actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
18721 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
18723 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
18727 124 if @var{command} times out, and @option{--preserve-status} is not specified
18728 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
18729 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18730 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18731 137 if @var{command} or @command{timeout} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
18732 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18735 In the case of the @samp{KILL(9)} signal, @command{timeout} returns with
18736 exit status 137, regardless of whether that signal is sent to @var{command}
18737 or to @command{timeout} itself, i.e., these cases cannot be distinguished.
18738 In the latter case, the @var{command} process may still be alive after
18739 @command{timeout} has forcefully been terminated.
18744 # Send the default TERM signal after 20s to a short-living 'sleep 1'.
18745 # As that terminates long before the given duration, 'timeout' returns
18746 # with the same exit status as the command, 0 in this case.
18749 # Send the INT signal after 5s to the 'sleep' command. Returns after
18750 # 5 seconds with exit status 124 to indicate the sending of the signal.
18751 timeout -s INT 5 sleep 20
18753 # Likewise, but the command ignoring the INT signal due to being started
18754 # via 'env --ignore-signal'. Thus, 'sleep' terminates regularly after
18755 # the full 20 seconds, still 'timeout' returns with exit status 124.
18756 timeout -s INT 5s env --ignore-signal=INT sleep 20
18758 # Likewise, but sending the KILL signal 3 seconds after the initial
18759 # INT signal. Hence, 'sleep' is forcefully terminated after about
18760 # 8 seconds (5+3), and 'timeout' returns with an exit status of 137.
18761 timeout -s INT -k 3s 5s env --ignore-signal=INT sleep 20
18764 @node Process control
18765 @chapter Process control
18767 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
18768 @cindex commands for controlling processes
18771 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
18775 @node kill invocation
18776 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
18779 @cindex send a signal to processes
18781 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
18782 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
18783 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
18786 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
18787 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
18790 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
18792 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
18793 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
18794 is @samp{TERM}@. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
18795 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
18796 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
18798 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
18799 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
18800 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
18801 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
18802 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
18803 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
18804 value of @var{pid}.
18806 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
18807 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
18810 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
18811 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
18812 POSIX, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
18813 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
18822 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
18823 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
18825 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
18826 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
18827 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
18828 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
18829 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
18830 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
18831 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
18832 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
18833 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
18834 and if there is no output error.
18836 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
18837 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
18839 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
18840 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
18841 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
18842 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
18843 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
18844 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
18845 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
18846 signal names and numbers.
18851 @cindex delaying commands
18852 @cindex commands for delaying
18854 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
18857 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
18861 @node sleep invocation
18862 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
18865 @cindex delay for a specified time
18867 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
18868 the values of the command line arguments.
18872 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
18876 Each argument is a non-negative number followed by an optional unit; the default
18877 is seconds. The units are:
18890 Although portable POSIX scripts must give @command{sleep} a single
18891 non-negative integer argument without a suffix, GNU @command{sleep}
18892 also accepts two or more arguments, unit suffixes, and floating-point
18893 numbers in either the current or the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
18895 For instance, the following could be used to @command{sleep} for
18896 1 second, 234 milli-, 567 micro- and 890 nanoseconds:
18899 sleep 1234e-3 567.89e-6
18902 Also one could sleep indefinitely like:
18908 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
18911 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
18912 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
18917 @node Numeric operations
18918 @chapter Numeric operations
18920 @cindex numeric operations
18921 These programs do numerically-related operations.
18924 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
18925 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers.
18926 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
18930 @node factor invocation
18931 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
18934 @cindex prime factors
18936 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopsis:
18939 factor [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]@dots{}
18942 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
18943 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
18945 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18951 @opindex --exponents
18952 print factors in the form @math{p^e}, rather than repeating
18953 the prime @samp{p}, @samp{e} times. If the exponent @samp{e} is 1,
18954 then it is omitted.
18957 $ factor --exponents 3000
18962 If the number to be factored is small (less than @math{2^{127}} on
18963 typical machines), @command{factor} uses a faster algorithm.
18964 For example, on a circa-2017 Intel Xeon Silver 4116, factoring the
18965 product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes (approximately
18966 @math{2^{92}}) takes about 4 ms of CPU time:
18969 $ M8=$(echo 2^31-1 | bc)
18970 $ M9=$(echo 2^61-1 | bc)
18971 $ n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
18972 $ bash -c "time factor $n"
18973 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
18980 For larger numbers, @command{factor} uses a slower algorithm. On the
18981 same platform, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256} + 1}
18982 takes about 14 seconds, and the slower algorithm would have taken
18983 about 750 ms to factor @math{2^{127} - 3} instead of the 50 ms needed by
18984 the faster algorithm.
18986 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard-Brent rho
18987 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
18988 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
18989 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
18990 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
18995 @node numfmt invocation
18996 @section @command{numfmt}: Reformat numbers
19000 @command{numfmt} reads numbers in various representations and reformats them
19001 as requested. The most common usage is converting numbers to/from @emph{human}
19002 representation (e.g. @samp{4G} @expansion{} @samp{4,000,000,000}).
19005 numfmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]
19008 @command{numfmt} converts each @var{number} on the command-line according to the
19009 specified options (see below). If no @var{number}s are given, it reads numbers
19010 from standard input. @command{numfmt} can optionally extract numbers from
19011 specific columns, maintaining proper line padding and alignment.
19015 See @option{--invalid} for additional information regarding exit status.
19017 @subsection General options
19019 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
19025 Print (to standard error) warning messages about possible erroneous usage.
19028 @itemx --delimiter=@var{d}
19030 @opindex --delimiter
19031 Use the character @var{d} as input field separator (default: whitespace).
19032 @emph{Note}: Using non-default delimiter turns off automatic padding.
19034 @item --field=@var{fields}
19036 Convert the number in input field @var{fields} (default: 1).
19037 @var{fields} supports @command{cut} style field ranges:
19040 N N'th field, counted from 1
19041 N- from N'th field, to end of line
19042 N-M from N'th to M'th field (inclusive)
19043 -M from first to M'th field (inclusive)
19048 @item --format=@var{format}
19050 Use printf-style floating FORMAT string. The @var{format} string must contain
19051 one @samp{%f} directive, optionally with @samp{'}, @samp{-}, @samp{0}, width
19052 or precision modifiers. The @samp{'} modifier will enable @option{--grouping},
19053 the @samp{-} modifier will enable left-aligned @option{--padding} and the width
19054 modifier will enable right-aligned @option{--padding}. The @samp{0} width
19055 modifier (without the @samp{-} modifier) will generate leading zeros on the
19056 number, up to the specified width. A precision specification like @samp{%.1f}
19057 will override the precision determined from the input data or set due to
19058 @option{--to} option auto scaling.
19060 @item --from=@var{unit}
19062 Auto-scales input numbers according to @var{unit}. See UNITS below.
19063 The default is no scaling, meaning suffixes (e.g. @samp{M}, @samp{G}) will
19066 @item --from-unit=@var{n}
19067 @opindex --from-unit
19068 Specify the input unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
19069 the input numbers represent other units (e.g. if the input number @samp{10}
19070 represents 10 units of 512 bytes, use @samp{--from-unit=512}).
19071 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
19074 @opindex --grouping
19075 Group digits in output numbers according to the current locale's grouping rules
19076 (e.g @emph{Thousands Separator} character, commonly @samp{.} (dot) or @samp{,}
19077 comma). This option has no effect in @samp{POSIX/C} locale.
19079 @item --header[=@var{n}]
19081 @opindex --header=N
19082 Print the first @var{n} (default: 1) lines without any conversion.
19084 @item --invalid=@var{mode}
19086 The default action on input errors is to exit immediately with status code 2.
19087 @option{--invalid=@samp{abort}} explicitly specifies this default mode.
19088 With a @var{mode} of @samp{fail}, print a warning for @emph{each} conversion
19089 error, and exit with status 2. With a @var{mode} of @samp{warn}, exit with
19090 status 0, even in the presence of conversion errors, and with a @var{mode} of
19091 @samp{ignore} do not even print diagnostics.
19093 @item --padding=@var{n}
19095 Pad the output numbers to @var{n} characters, by adding spaces. If @var{n} is
19096 a positive number, numbers will be right-aligned. If @var{n} is a negative
19097 number, numbers will be left-aligned. By default, numbers are automatically
19098 aligned based on the input line's width (only with the default delimiter).
19100 @item --round=@var{method}
19102 @opindex --round=up
19103 @opindex --round=down
19104 @opindex --round=from-zero
19105 @opindex --round=towards-zero
19106 @opindex --round=nearest
19107 When converting number representations, round the number according to
19108 @var{method}, which can be @samp{up}, @samp{down},
19109 @samp{from-zero} (the default), @samp{towards-zero}, @samp{nearest}.
19111 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
19113 Add @samp{SUFFIX} to the output numbers, and accept optional @samp{SUFFIX} in
19116 @item --to=@var{unit}
19118 Auto-scales output numbers according to @var{unit}. See @emph{Units} below.
19119 The default is no scaling, meaning all the digits of the number are printed.
19121 @item --to-unit=@var{n}
19123 Specify the output unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
19124 the output numbers represent other units (e.g. to represent @samp{4,000,000}
19125 bytes in blocks of 1kB, use @samp{--to=si --to-unit=1000}).
19126 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
19129 @newlineFieldSeparator
19133 @subsection Possible @var{unit}s:
19135 The following are the possible @var{unit} options with @option{--from=UNITS} and
19136 @option{--to=UNITS}:
19141 No scaling is performed. For input numbers, no suffixes are accepted, and any
19142 trailing characters following the number will trigger an error. For output
19143 numbers, all digits of the numbers will be printed.
19146 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International System of Units (SI)}
19148 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19149 For output numbers, values larger than 1000 will be rounded, and printed with
19150 one of the following suffixes:
19153 @samp{K} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo) (uppercase accepted on input)
19154 @samp{k} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo) (lowercase used on output)
19155 @samp{M} => @math{1000^2 = 10^6} (Mega)
19156 @samp{G} => @math{1000^3 = 10^9} (Giga)
19157 @samp{T} => @math{1000^4 = 10^{12}} (Tera)
19158 @samp{P} => @math{1000^5 = 10^{15}} (Peta)
19159 @samp{E} => @math{1000^6 = 10^{18}} (Exa)
19160 @samp{Z} => @math{1000^7 = 10^{21}} (Zetta)
19161 @samp{Y} => @math{1000^8 = 10^{24}} (Yotta)
19162 @samp{R} => @math{1000^9 = 10^{27}} (Ronna)
19163 @samp{Q} => @math{1000^{10} = 10^{30}} (Quetta)
19167 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
19168 Commission (IEC)} standard.
19169 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19170 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
19171 one of the following suffixes:
19174 @samp{K} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (uppercase used on output)
19175 @samp{k} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (lowercase accepted on input)
19176 @samp{M} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
19177 @samp{G} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
19178 @samp{T} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
19179 @samp{P} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
19180 @samp{E} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
19181 @samp{Z} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
19182 @samp{Y} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
19183 @samp{R} => @math{1024^9 = 2^{90}} (Robi)
19184 @samp{Q} => @math{1024^{10} = 2^{100}} (Quebi)
19187 The @option{iec} option uses a single letter suffix (e.g. @samp{G}), which is
19188 not fully standard, as the @emph{iec} standard recommends a two-letter symbol
19189 (e.g @samp{Gi}) -- but in practice, this method is common. Compare with
19190 the @option{iec-i} option.
19193 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
19194 Commission (IEC)} standard.
19195 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19196 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
19197 one of the following suffixes:
19200 @samp{Ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (uppercase used on output)
19201 @samp{ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (lowercase accepted on input)
19202 @samp{Mi} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
19203 @samp{Gi} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
19204 @samp{Ti} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
19205 @samp{Pi} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
19206 @samp{Ei} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
19207 @samp{Zi} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
19208 @samp{Yi} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
19209 @samp{Ri} => @math{1024^9 = 2^{90}} (Robi)
19210 @samp{Qi} => @math{1024^{10} = 2^{100}} (Quebi)
19213 The @option{iec-i} option uses a two-letter suffix symbol (e.g. @samp{Gi}),
19214 as the @emph{iec} standard recommends, but this is not always common in
19215 practice. Compare with the @option{iec} option.
19218 @samp{auto} can only be used with @option{--from}. With this method, numbers
19219 with single-letter suffixes like @samp{K}
19220 suffixes are interpreted as @emph{SI} values, and numbers with
19221 two-letter suffixes like @samp{Ki}
19222 are interpreted as @emph{IEC} values.
19226 @subsection Examples of using @command{numfmt}
19228 Converting a single number from/to @emph{human} representation:
19230 $ numfmt --to=si 500000
19233 $ numfmt --to=iec 500000
19236 $ numfmt --to=iec-i 500000
19239 $ numfmt --from=si 1M
19242 $ numfmt --from=iec 1M
19245 # with '--from=auto', M=Mega, Mi=Mebi
19246 $ numfmt --from=auto 1M
19248 $ numfmt --from=auto 1Mi
19252 Converting from @samp{SI} to @samp{IEC} scales (e.g. when a drive's capacity is
19253 advertised as @samp{1TB}, while checking the drive's capacity gives lower
19257 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec 1T
19261 With both input and output scales specified,
19262 the largest defined prefixes are supported:
19265 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec-i 2000R
19269 Converting a single field from an input file / piped input (these contrived
19270 examples are for demonstration purposes only, as both @command{ls} and
19271 @command{df} support the @option{--human-readable} option to
19272 output sizes in human-readable format):
19275 # Third field (file size) will be shown in SI representation
19276 $ ls -log | numfmt --field 3 --header --to=si | head -n4
19277 -rw-r--r-- 1 94k Aug 23 2011 ABOUT-NLS
19278 -rw-r--r-- 1 3.7k Jan 7 16:15 AUTHORS
19279 -rw-r--r-- 1 36k Jun 1 2011 COPYING
19280 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jan 7 15:15 ChangeLog
19282 # Second field (size) will be shown in IEC representation
19283 $ df --block-size=1 | numfmt --field 2 --header --to=iec | head -n4
19284 File system 1B-blocks Used Available Use% Mounted on
19285 rootfs 132G 104741408 26554036 80% /
19286 tmpfs 794M 7580 804960 1% /run/shm
19287 /dev/sdb1 694G 651424756 46074696 94% /home
19291 Output can be tweaked using @option{--padding} or @option{--format}:
19294 # Pad to 10 characters, right-aligned
19295 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=10
19301 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned
19302 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=-10
19308 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
19309 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --format="%10f"
19315 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
19316 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding="%-10f"
19323 With locales that support grouping digits, using @option{--grouping} or
19324 @option{--format} enables grouping. In @samp{POSIX} locale, grouping is
19328 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19331 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19334 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19337 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19340 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19343 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'-15f==" 2G
19346 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19347 == 2,14,74,83,648==
19351 @node seq invocation
19352 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
19355 @cindex numeric sequences
19356 @cindex sequence of numbers
19358 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
19361 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
19362 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
19363 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
19366 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
19367 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
19368 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
19369 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
19370 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
19371 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
19372 The sequence of numbers ends when the sum of the current number and
19373 @var{increment} would become greater than @var{last},
19374 so @code{seq 1 10 10} only produces @samp{1}.
19375 @var{increment} must not be @samp{0}; use the tool @command{yes} to get
19376 repeated output of a constant number.
19377 @var{first}, @var{increment} and @var{last} must not be @code{NaN},
19378 but @code{inf} is supported.
19379 Floating-point numbers may be specified in either the current or
19380 the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
19382 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
19383 Options must precede operands.
19386 @item -f @var{format}
19387 @itemx --format=@var{format}
19390 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
19391 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
19392 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
19393 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
19394 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}@.
19395 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
19396 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
19397 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
19398 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
19399 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
19400 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
19402 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
19403 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
19404 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
19405 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
19406 the default format is @samp{%g}.
19408 @item -s @var{string}
19409 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
19411 @opindex --separator
19412 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
19413 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
19414 The output always terminates with a newline.
19417 @itemx --equal-width
19419 @opindex --equal-width
19420 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
19421 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
19422 decimal representation.
19423 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
19427 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
19430 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
19436 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
19437 to perform the conversion:
19440 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
19446 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
19447 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
19450 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
19456 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
19459 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
19460 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
19461 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
19462 @xref{Floating point}. A common
19463 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
19464 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
19467 $ seq 50000000000000000000 2 50000000000000000004
19468 50000000000000000000
19469 50000000000000000000
19470 50000000000000000004
19473 However, note that when limited to non-negative whole numbers,
19474 an increment of less than 200, and no format-specifying option,
19475 seq can print arbitrarily large numbers.
19476 Therefore @command{seq inf} can be used to
19477 generate an infinite sequence of numbers.
19479 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
19480 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
19481 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
19482 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
19485 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
19488 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
19493 @node File permissions
19494 @chapter File permissions
19498 @node File timestamps
19499 @chapter File timestamps
19505 Standard POSIX files have three timestamps: the access timestamp
19506 (atime) of the last read, the modification timestamp (mtime) of the
19507 last write, and the status change timestamp (ctime) of the last change
19508 to the file's meta-information. Some file systems support a
19509 fourth time: the birth timestamp (birthtime) of when the file was
19510 created; by definition, birthtime never changes.
19512 One common example of a ctime change is when the permissions of a file
19513 change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so atime
19514 doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime doesn't
19515 change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed, and this
19516 must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field. This is
19517 necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a fresh
19518 copy of the file, including the new permissions value. Another
19519 operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting the others is
19522 Naively, a file's atime, mtime, and ctime are set to the current time
19523 whenever you read, write, or change the attributes of the file
19524 respectively, and searching a directory counts as reading it. A
19525 file's atime and mtime can also be set directly, via the
19526 @command{touch} command (@pxref{touch invocation}). In practice,
19527 though, timestamps are not updated quite that way.
19529 For efficiency reasons, many systems are lazy about updating atimes:
19530 when a program accesses a file, they may delay updating the file's
19531 atime, or may not update the file's atime if the file has been
19532 accessed recently, or may not update the atime at all. Similar
19533 laziness, though typically not quite so extreme, applies to mtimes and
19536 Some systems emulate timestamps instead of supporting them directly,
19537 and these emulations may disagree with the naive interpretation. For
19538 example, a system may fake an atime or ctime by using the mtime.
19541 The determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
19542 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
19543 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
19544 updates typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
19545 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
19546 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
19548 @cindex file timestamp resolution
19549 When the system updates a file timestamp to a desired time @var{t}
19550 (which is either the current time, or a time specified via the
19551 @command{touch} command), there are several reasons the file's
19552 timestamp may be set to a value that differs from @var{t}. First,
19553 @var{t} may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a file
19554 system may use different resolutions for different types of times.
19555 Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than operating
19556 system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives used to
19557 update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For example,
19558 in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution for access
19559 timestamp and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification timestamp, and the
19560 operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the current time
19561 and microsecond resolution for the primitive that @command{touch} uses
19562 to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
19565 @include parse-datetime.texi
19567 @include sort-version.texi
19571 @node Opening the software toolbox
19572 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
19574 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
19575 @uref{https://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
19576 @cite{What's GNU@?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
19577 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
19580 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
19581 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
19582 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
19583 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
19584 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
19585 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
19586 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
19590 @node Toolbox introduction
19591 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
19593 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
19594 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
19596 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
19597 of program development and usage.
19599 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
19600 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which GNU/Linux and GNU are
19601 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
19602 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
19603 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
19604 for solving many kinds of problems.
19606 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
19607 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
19608 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
19609 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
19610 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
19612 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
19613 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
19614 tools -- a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
19615 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
19616 with the handle of his screwdriver.
19618 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
19619 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
19620 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
19625 difficult to write,
19628 difficult to maintain and
19632 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
19635 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
19636 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
19637 simpler to design, write, and get right -- they only do one thing.
19639 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
19640 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
19641 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
19642 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
19643 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
19644 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
19645 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
19646 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
19647 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
19649 @node I/O redirection
19650 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
19652 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
19653 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
19654 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
19655 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
19656 data source is a regular file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
19657 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
19658 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
19659 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
19660 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
19663 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
19666 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
19669 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
19670 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
19671 it is in the desired form.
19673 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
19674 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
19675 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
19676 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
19677 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
19678 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
19679 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
19680 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
19681 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
19683 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
19684 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
19685 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
19686 lines delimited by the ASCII LF (Line Feed) character,
19687 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
19688 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
19689 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
19690 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
19691 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
19692 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
19693 data with a text editor.)
19695 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
19696 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
19697 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
19698 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
19699 for the full story.
19701 @node The who command
19702 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
19704 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
19705 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
19706 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
19711 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
19712 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
19713 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
19714 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
19717 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
19718 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
19719 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
19720 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
19721 but the data is not all that exciting.
19723 @node The cut command
19724 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
19726 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
19727 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
19728 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
19729 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
19733 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
19736 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
19739 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
19740 @print{} root:Operator
19742 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
19743 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
19747 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
19748 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
19749 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
19750 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
19752 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
19763 @node The sort command
19764 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
19766 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
19767 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
19768 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
19771 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
19772 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
19773 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
19774 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
19775 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
19778 @node The uniq command
19779 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
19781 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
19782 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
19783 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
19784 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
19785 standard input. It prints only one
19786 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
19787 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
19788 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
19791 @node Putting the tools together
19792 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
19794 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
19795 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
19797 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
19798 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
19801 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
19802 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
19803 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
19804 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
19805 by generating just a list of logged on users:
19815 Next, sort the list:
19818 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
19825 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
19828 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
19834 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
19835 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
19836 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
19838 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
19840 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
19841 or @code{root}, prompt):
19844 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
19845 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
19847 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
19850 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
19851 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
19852 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
19853 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
19854 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
19855 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
19856 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
19859 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
19860 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
19861 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
19863 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
19864 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
19865 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
19867 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
19868 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
19869 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
19872 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
19873 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
19875 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
19876 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
19877 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
19881 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
19882 @print{} this example has mixed case!
19885 There are several options of interest:
19889 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
19890 operations apply to characters not in the given set
19893 delete characters in the first set from the output
19896 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
19899 We will be using all three options in a moment.
19901 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
19902 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
19903 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
19904 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
19905 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
19906 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
19907 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
19929 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
19930 instead of a regular file.
19932 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
19933 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
19936 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
19937 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
19940 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
19943 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
19944 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
19948 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
19951 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
19952 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
19953 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
19954 be left alone. (The ASCII tab character should also be included for
19955 good measure in a production script.)
19957 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
19958 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
19959 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
19960 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
19963 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19964 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
19967 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
19968 multiple newline characters in the output into just one, removing
19969 blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
19970 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
19971 typing in all of a command.)
19973 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
19974 case. We're ready to count each word:
19977 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19978 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
19981 At this point, the data might look something like this:
19994 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
19995 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
19996 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
20000 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
20003 reverse the order of the sort
20006 The final pipeline looks like this:
20009 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20010 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
20019 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
20020 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
20021 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
20022 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
20024 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
20025 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
20026 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
20027 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
20028 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/share/dict/words}.
20030 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
20031 a sorted list of words, one per line:
20034 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20035 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
20038 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
20039 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
20040 Unfortunately @command{comm} operates on sorted input and
20041 @file{/usr/share/dict/words} is not sorted the way that @command{sort}
20042 and @command{comm} normally use, so we first create a properly-sorted
20043 copy of the dictionary and then run a pipeline that uses the copy.
20046 $ sort /usr/share/dict/words > sorted-words
20047 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20048 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
20049 > comm -23 - sorted-words
20052 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
20053 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
20054 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
20055 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
20056 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
20057 spelling checker on Unix.
20059 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
20063 search files for text that matches a regular expression
20066 count lines, words, characters
20069 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
20072 the stream editor, an advanced tool
20075 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
20078 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
20079 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
20080 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
20081 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
20087 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
20090 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
20091 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
20092 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
20095 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
20096 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
20099 Let someone else do the hard part.
20102 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
20103 appropriate tool, build one.
20106 All the programs discussed are available as described in
20107 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/coreutils/coreutils.html,
20108 GNU core utilities}.
20110 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
20111 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
20112 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
20113 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
20114 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
20115 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
20116 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
20117 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
20118 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
20121 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
20122 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
20123 still in print and are well worth
20124 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
20125 how I view programming.
20127 The programs in both books are available from
20128 @uref{https://www.cs.princeton.edu/~bwk/, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
20129 For a number of years, there was an active
20130 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
20131 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
20132 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
20133 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
20135 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
20136 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
20137 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
20138 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
20139 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
20141 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
20142 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
20144 @node GNU Free Documentation License
20145 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
20149 @node Concept index
20156 @c Local variables:
20157 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32